ada: Further cleanup in finalization machinery
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.cc
blob9fef2bf65853954ffcc2800006d7363e20aab274
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 This file is part of GCC.
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
7 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
8 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
9 version.
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
12 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
13 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
14 for more details.
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 #include "config.h"
21 #include "system.h"
22 #include "coretypes.h"
23 #include "backend.h"
24 #include "target.h"
25 #include "rtl.h"
26 #include "tree.h"
27 #include "gimple.h"
28 #include "predict.h"
29 #include "memmodel.h"
30 #include "tm_p.h"
31 #include "ssa.h"
32 #include "optabs.h"
33 #include "expmed.h"
34 #include "regs.h"
35 #include "emit-rtl.h"
36 #include "recog.h"
37 #include "cgraph.h"
38 #include "diagnostic.h"
39 #include "alias.h"
40 #include "fold-const.h"
41 #include "stor-layout.h"
42 #include "attribs.h"
43 #include "varasm.h"
44 #include "except.h"
45 #include "insn-attr.h"
46 #include "dojump.h"
47 #include "explow.h"
48 #include "calls.h"
49 #include "stmt.h"
50 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
51 #include "expr.h"
52 #include "optabs-tree.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "reload.h"
55 #include "langhooks.h"
56 #include "common/common-target.h"
57 #include "tree-dfa.h"
58 #include "tree-ssa-live.h"
59 #include "tree-outof-ssa.h"
60 #include "tree-ssa-address.h"
61 #include "builtins.h"
62 #include "ccmp.h"
63 #include "gimple-iterator.h"
64 #include "gimple-fold.h"
65 #include "rtx-vector-builder.h"
66 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
67 #include "flags.h"
70 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
71 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
72 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
73 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
74 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
75 the same indirect address eventually. */
76 int cse_not_expected;
78 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
79 static bool emit_block_move_via_pattern (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned,
80 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
81 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
82 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, bool);
83 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, int);
84 static void emit_block_move_via_sized_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned);
85 static void emit_block_move_via_oriented_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned);
86 static rtx emit_block_cmp_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, tree, rtx, bool,
87 unsigned, unsigned);
88 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
89 static rtx_insn *compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
90 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
91 static rtx store_field (rtx, poly_int64, poly_int64, poly_uint64, poly_uint64,
92 machine_mode, tree, alias_set_type, bool, bool);
94 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
96 static bool is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
97 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
98 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, machine_mode);
99 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
100 static void emit_single_push_insn (machine_mode, rtx, tree);
101 #endif
102 static void do_tablejump (rtx, machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx,
103 profile_probability);
104 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
105 static tree tree_expr_size (const_tree);
106 static void convert_mode_scalar (rtx, rtx, int);
109 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
110 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
111 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
113 void
114 init_expr_target (void)
116 rtx pat;
117 int num_clobbers;
118 rtx mem, mem1;
119 rtx reg;
121 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
122 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
123 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
124 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, stack_pointer_rtx);
125 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (word_mode, frame_pointer_rtx);
127 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
128 useless RTL allocations. */
129 reg = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
131 rtx_insn *insn = as_a<rtx_insn *> (rtx_alloc (INSN));
132 pat = gen_rtx_SET (NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
133 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
135 for (machine_mode mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
136 mode = (machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
138 int regno;
140 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
141 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
142 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
144 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
145 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
147 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
148 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
149 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
150 regno++)
152 if (!targetm.hard_regno_mode_ok (regno, mode))
153 continue;
155 set_mode_and_regno (reg, mode, regno);
157 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
158 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
159 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
160 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
162 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
163 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
164 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
165 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
167 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
168 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
169 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
170 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
172 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
173 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
174 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
175 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
179 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_raw_REG (Pmode, LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1));
181 opt_scalar_float_mode mode_iter;
182 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_FLOAT)
184 scalar_float_mode mode = mode_iter.require ();
185 scalar_float_mode srcmode;
186 FOR_EACH_MODE_UNTIL (srcmode, mode)
188 enum insn_code ic;
190 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
191 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
192 continue;
194 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
196 if (insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, mem))
197 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
202 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
204 void
205 init_expr (void)
207 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
210 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
211 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
212 fixed-point.
213 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
214 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
216 void
217 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
219 machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
220 machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
222 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
223 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
225 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
226 nothing to do. */
227 if (to == from)
228 return;
230 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
231 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
232 TO here. */
234 scalar_int_mode to_int_mode;
235 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG
236 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
237 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (to_mode, &to_int_mode)
238 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (subreg_promoted_mode (from))
239 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_int_mode))
240 && SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (from, unsignedp))
242 scalar_int_mode int_orig_mode;
243 scalar_int_mode int_inner_mode;
244 machine_mode orig_mode = GET_MODE (from);
246 from = gen_lowpart (to_int_mode, SUBREG_REG (from));
247 from_mode = to_int_mode;
249 /* Preserve SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P if the new mode is wider than
250 the original mode, but narrower than the inner mode. */
251 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG
252 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (orig_mode, &int_orig_mode)
253 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_int_mode)
254 > GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_orig_mode)
255 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)),
256 &int_inner_mode)
257 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_inner_mode)
258 > GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_int_mode))
260 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from) = 1;
261 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SET (from, unsignedp);
265 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
267 if (to_mode == from_mode
268 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
270 emit_move_insn (to, from);
271 return;
274 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
276 if (GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (to_mode)
277 > GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (from_mode))
279 optab op = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
280 insn_code icode = convert_optab_handler (op, to_mode, from_mode);
281 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
283 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from,
284 unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND);
285 return;
289 if (GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (to_mode)
290 < GET_MODE_UNIT_PRECISION (from_mode))
292 insn_code icode = convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab,
293 to_mode, from_mode);
294 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
296 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, TRUNCATE);
297 return;
301 gcc_assert (known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode),
302 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)));
304 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
305 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
306 else
307 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
309 emit_move_insn (to, from);
310 return;
313 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
315 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
316 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
317 return;
320 convert_mode_scalar (to, from, unsignedp);
323 /* Like convert_move, but deals only with scalar modes. */
325 static void
326 convert_mode_scalar (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
328 /* Both modes should be scalar types. */
329 scalar_mode from_mode = as_a <scalar_mode> (GET_MODE (from));
330 scalar_mode to_mode = as_a <scalar_mode> (GET_MODE (to));
331 bool to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
332 bool from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
333 enum insn_code code;
334 rtx libcall;
336 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
338 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
339 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
340 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
342 if (to_real)
344 rtx value;
345 rtx_insn *insns;
346 convert_optab tab;
348 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
349 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
350 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
351 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode))
352 || (REAL_MODE_FORMAT (from_mode) == &arm_bfloat_half_format
353 && REAL_MODE_FORMAT (to_mode) == &ieee_half_format)
354 || (REAL_MODE_FORMAT (to_mode) == &arm_bfloat_half_format
355 && REAL_MODE_FORMAT (from_mode) == &ieee_half_format));
357 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
358 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
359 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
360 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
361 tab = sext_optab;
362 else
363 tab = trunc_optab;
365 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
367 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
368 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
370 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
371 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
372 return;
375 #ifdef HAVE_SFmode
376 if (REAL_MODE_FORMAT (from_mode) == &arm_bfloat_half_format
377 && REAL_MODE_FORMAT (SFmode) == &ieee_single_format)
379 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (SFmode))
381 /* To cut down on libgcc size, implement
382 BFmode -> {DF,XF,TF}mode conversions by
383 BFmode -> SFmode -> {DF,XF,TF}mode conversions. */
384 rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (SFmode);
385 convert_mode_scalar (temp, from, unsignedp);
386 convert_mode_scalar (to, temp, unsignedp);
387 return;
389 if (REAL_MODE_FORMAT (to_mode) == &ieee_half_format)
391 /* Similarly, implement BFmode -> HFmode as
392 BFmode -> SFmode -> HFmode conversion where SFmode
393 has superset of BFmode values. We don't need
394 to handle sNaNs by raising exception and turning
395 into into qNaN though, as that can be done in the
396 SFmode -> HFmode conversion too. */
397 rtx temp = gen_reg_rtx (SFmode);
398 int save_flag_finite_math_only = flag_finite_math_only;
399 flag_finite_math_only = true;
400 convert_mode_scalar (temp, from, unsignedp);
401 flag_finite_math_only = save_flag_finite_math_only;
402 convert_mode_scalar (to, temp, unsignedp);
403 return;
405 if (to_mode == SFmode
406 && !HONOR_NANS (from_mode)
407 && !HONOR_NANS (to_mode)
408 && optimize_insn_for_speed_p ())
410 /* If we don't expect sNaNs, for BFmode -> SFmode we can just
411 shift the bits up. */
412 machine_mode fromi_mode, toi_mode;
413 if (int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode),
414 0).exists (&fromi_mode)
415 && int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
416 0).exists (&toi_mode))
418 start_sequence ();
419 rtx fromi = lowpart_subreg (fromi_mode, from, from_mode);
420 rtx tof = NULL_RTX;
421 if (fromi)
423 rtx toi;
424 if (GET_MODE (fromi) == VOIDmode)
425 toi = simplify_unary_operation (ZERO_EXTEND, toi_mode,
426 fromi, fromi_mode);
427 else
429 toi = gen_reg_rtx (toi_mode);
430 convert_mode_scalar (toi, fromi, 1);
433 = maybe_expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, toi_mode, toi,
434 GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
435 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode),
436 NULL_RTX, 1);
437 if (toi)
439 tof = lowpart_subreg (to_mode, toi, toi_mode);
440 if (tof)
441 emit_move_insn (to, tof);
444 insns = get_insns ();
445 end_sequence ();
446 if (tof)
448 emit_insn (insns);
449 return;
454 if (REAL_MODE_FORMAT (from_mode) == &ieee_single_format
455 && REAL_MODE_FORMAT (to_mode) == &arm_bfloat_half_format
456 && !HONOR_NANS (from_mode)
457 && !HONOR_NANS (to_mode)
458 && !flag_rounding_math
459 && optimize_insn_for_speed_p ())
461 /* If we don't expect qNaNs nor sNaNs and can assume rounding
462 to nearest, we can expand the conversion inline as
463 (fromi + 0x7fff + ((fromi >> 16) & 1)) >> 16. */
464 machine_mode fromi_mode, toi_mode;
465 if (int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode),
466 0).exists (&fromi_mode)
467 && int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
468 0).exists (&toi_mode))
470 start_sequence ();
471 rtx fromi = lowpart_subreg (fromi_mode, from, from_mode);
472 rtx tof = NULL_RTX;
475 if (!fromi)
476 break;
477 int shift = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
478 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode));
479 rtx temp1
480 = maybe_expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, fromi_mode, fromi,
481 shift, NULL_RTX, 1);
482 if (!temp1)
483 break;
484 rtx temp2
485 = expand_binop (fromi_mode, and_optab, temp1, const1_rtx,
486 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_DIRECT);
487 if (!temp2)
488 break;
489 rtx temp3
490 = expand_binop (fromi_mode, add_optab, fromi,
491 gen_int_mode ((HOST_WIDE_INT_1U
492 << (shift - 1)) - 1,
493 fromi_mode), NULL_RTX,
494 1, OPTAB_DIRECT);
495 if (!temp3)
496 break;
497 rtx temp4
498 = expand_binop (fromi_mode, add_optab, temp3, temp2,
499 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_DIRECT);
500 if (!temp4)
501 break;
502 rtx temp5 = maybe_expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, fromi_mode,
503 temp4, shift, NULL_RTX, 1);
504 if (!temp5)
505 break;
506 rtx temp6 = lowpart_subreg (toi_mode, temp5, fromi_mode);
507 if (!temp6)
508 break;
509 tof = lowpart_subreg (to_mode, force_reg (toi_mode, temp6),
510 toi_mode);
511 if (tof)
512 emit_move_insn (to, tof);
514 while (0);
515 insns = get_insns ();
516 end_sequence ();
517 if (tof)
519 emit_insn (insns);
520 return;
524 #endif
526 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
527 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
529 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
530 gcc_assert (libcall);
532 start_sequence ();
533 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
534 from, from_mode);
535 insns = get_insns ();
536 end_sequence ();
537 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
538 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
539 from)
540 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
541 return;
544 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
545 /* If the target has a converter from FROM_MODE to TO_MODE, use it. */
547 convert_optab ctab;
549 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
550 ctab = trunc_optab;
551 else if (unsignedp)
552 ctab = zext_optab;
553 else
554 ctab = sext_optab;
556 if (convert_optab_handler (ctab, to_mode, from_mode)
557 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
559 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (ctab, to_mode, from_mode),
560 to, from, UNKNOWN);
561 return;
565 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
566 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
567 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
569 scalar_int_mode full_mode
570 = smallest_int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
572 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
573 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
575 if (full_mode != from_mode)
576 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
577 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
578 to, from, UNKNOWN);
579 return;
581 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
583 rtx new_from;
584 scalar_int_mode full_mode
585 = smallest_int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode));
586 convert_optab ctab = unsignedp ? zext_optab : sext_optab;
587 enum insn_code icode;
589 icode = convert_optab_handler (ctab, full_mode, from_mode);
590 gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
592 if (to_mode == full_mode)
594 emit_unop_insn (icode, to, from, UNKNOWN);
595 return;
598 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
599 emit_unop_insn (icode, new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
601 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
602 from_mode = full_mode;
603 from = new_from;
606 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
607 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
608 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
609 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
611 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
612 we won't saturate the result.
613 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
614 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
615 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
616 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
617 else
618 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
619 return;
622 /* Now both modes are integers. */
624 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
625 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
626 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
628 rtx_insn *insns;
629 rtx lowpart;
630 rtx fill_value;
631 rtx lowfrom;
632 int i;
633 scalar_mode lowpart_mode;
634 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
636 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
637 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
638 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
640 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
641 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
642 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
643 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
644 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
645 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
646 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
647 return;
649 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
650 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
651 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
652 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
654 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
655 if (REG_P (to))
657 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
658 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
659 emit_clobber (to);
661 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
662 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
663 return;
666 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
667 start_sequence ();
669 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
670 the source does not overlap the target so force it into an isolated
671 register when maybe so. Likewise for any MEM input, since the
672 conversion sequence might require several references to it and we
673 must ensure we're getting the same value every time. */
675 if (MEM_P (from) || reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
676 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
678 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
679 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
680 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
681 else
682 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
684 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
686 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
687 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
689 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
690 if (unsignedp)
691 fill_value = const0_rtx;
692 else
693 fill_value = emit_store_flag_force (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
694 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
695 lowpart_mode, 0, -1);
697 /* Fill the remaining words. */
698 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
700 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
701 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
703 gcc_assert (subword);
705 if (fill_value != subword)
706 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
709 insns = get_insns ();
710 end_sequence ();
712 emit_insn (insns);
713 return;
716 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
717 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
718 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
720 if (!((MEM_P (from)
721 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
722 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
723 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
724 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
725 || REG_P (from)
726 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
727 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
728 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
729 return;
732 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
733 no more than a word long. */
735 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
736 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
737 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, from_mode))
739 if (!((MEM_P (from)
740 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
741 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
742 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0),
743 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from)))
744 || REG_P (from)
745 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
746 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
747 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
748 && !targetm.hard_regno_mode_ok (REGNO (from), to_mode))
749 from = copy_to_reg (from);
750 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
751 return;
754 /* Handle extension. */
755 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
757 /* Convert directly if that works. */
758 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
759 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
761 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
762 return;
764 else
766 rtx tmp;
767 int shift_amount;
769 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
770 opt_scalar_mode intermediate_iter;
771 FOR_EACH_MODE_FROM (intermediate_iter, from_mode)
773 scalar_mode intermediate = intermediate_iter.require ();
774 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
775 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
776 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
777 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode,
778 intermediate)))
779 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
780 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
782 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
783 unsignedp), unsignedp);
784 return;
788 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
789 Generate what we need with shifts. */
790 shift_amount = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
791 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode));
792 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
793 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
794 to, unsignedp);
795 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
796 to, unsignedp);
797 if (tmp != to)
798 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
799 return;
803 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
804 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
805 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
807 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
808 to, from, UNKNOWN);
809 return;
812 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
813 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
814 and for which there was no special instruction.
816 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
817 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
818 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
819 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
821 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
822 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
823 return;
826 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
827 gcc_unreachable ();
830 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
831 from converting X to mode MODE.
832 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
833 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
834 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
835 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
838 convert_to_mode (machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
840 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
843 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
844 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
845 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
846 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
848 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
849 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
851 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
854 convert_modes (machine_mode mode, machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
856 rtx temp;
857 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
859 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
860 the required extension, strip it. */
862 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
863 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
864 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode)
865 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (subreg_promoted_mode (x))
866 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode))
867 && SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (x, unsignedp))
869 scalar_int_mode int_orig_mode;
870 scalar_int_mode int_inner_mode;
871 machine_mode orig_mode = GET_MODE (x);
872 x = gen_lowpart (int_mode, SUBREG_REG (x));
874 /* Preserve SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P if the new mode is wider than
875 the original mode, but narrower than the inner mode. */
876 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
877 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (orig_mode, &int_orig_mode)
878 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode)
879 > GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_orig_mode)
880 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)),
881 &int_inner_mode)
882 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_inner_mode)
883 > GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode))
885 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x) = 1;
886 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SET (x, unsignedp);
890 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
891 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
893 if (mode == oldmode)
894 return x;
896 if (CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (x)
897 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode, &int_mode))
899 /* If the caller did not tell us the old mode, then there is not
900 much to do with respect to canonicalization. We have to
901 assume that all the bits are significant. */
902 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (oldmode))
903 oldmode = MAX_MODE_INT;
904 wide_int w = wide_int::from (rtx_mode_t (x, oldmode),
905 GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode),
906 unsignedp ? UNSIGNED : SIGNED);
907 return immed_wide_int_const (w, int_mode);
910 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
911 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
912 non-volatile MEM. */
913 scalar_int_mode int_oldmode;
914 if (is_int_mode (mode, &int_mode)
915 && is_int_mode (oldmode, &int_oldmode)
916 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode) <= GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_oldmode)
917 && ((MEM_P (x) && !MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) && direct_load[(int) int_mode])
918 || CONST_POLY_INT_P (x)
919 || (REG_P (x)
920 && (!HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
921 || targetm.hard_regno_mode_ok (REGNO (x), int_mode))
922 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (int_mode, GET_MODE (x)))))
923 return gen_lowpart (int_mode, x);
925 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
926 subreg operation. */
927 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
929 gcc_assert (known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
930 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode)));
931 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
934 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
935 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
936 return temp;
939 /* Variant of convert_modes for ABI parameter passing/return.
940 Return an rtx for a value that would result from converting X from
941 a floating point mode FMODE to wider integer mode MODE. */
944 convert_float_to_wider_int (machine_mode mode, machine_mode fmode, rtx x)
946 gcc_assert (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode) && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (fmode));
947 scalar_int_mode tmp_mode = int_mode_for_mode (fmode).require ();
948 rtx tmp = force_reg (tmp_mode, gen_lowpart (tmp_mode, x));
949 return convert_modes (mode, tmp_mode, tmp, 1);
952 /* Variant of convert_modes for ABI parameter passing/return.
953 Return an rtx for a value that would result from converting X from
954 an integer mode IMODE to a narrower floating point mode MODE. */
957 convert_wider_int_to_float (machine_mode mode, machine_mode imode, rtx x)
959 gcc_assert (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (imode));
960 scalar_int_mode tmp_mode = int_mode_for_mode (mode).require ();
961 rtx tmp = force_reg (tmp_mode, gen_lowpart (tmp_mode, x));
962 return gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, tmp);
965 /* Return the largest alignment we can use for doing a move (or store)
966 of MAX_PIECES. ALIGN is the largest alignment we could use. */
968 static unsigned int
969 alignment_for_piecewise_move (unsigned int max_pieces, unsigned int align)
971 scalar_int_mode tmode
972 = int_mode_for_size (max_pieces * BITS_PER_UNIT, 0).require ();
974 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
975 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
976 else
978 scalar_int_mode xmode = NARROWEST_INT_MODE;
979 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
980 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
982 tmode = mode_iter.require ();
983 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > max_pieces
984 || targetm.slow_unaligned_access (tmode, align))
985 break;
986 xmode = tmode;
989 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
992 return align;
995 /* Return true if we know how to implement OP using vectors of bytes. */
996 static bool
997 can_use_qi_vectors (by_pieces_operation op)
999 return (op == COMPARE_BY_PIECES
1000 || op == SET_BY_PIECES
1001 || op == CLEAR_BY_PIECES);
1004 /* Return true if optabs exists for the mode and certain by pieces
1005 operations. */
1006 static bool
1007 by_pieces_mode_supported_p (fixed_size_mode mode, by_pieces_operation op)
1009 if (optab_handler (mov_optab, mode) == CODE_FOR_nothing)
1010 return false;
1012 if ((op == SET_BY_PIECES || op == CLEAR_BY_PIECES)
1013 && VECTOR_MODE_P (mode)
1014 && optab_handler (vec_duplicate_optab, mode) == CODE_FOR_nothing)
1015 return false;
1017 if (op == COMPARE_BY_PIECES
1018 && !can_compare_p (EQ, mode, ccp_jump))
1019 return false;
1021 return true;
1024 /* Return the widest mode that can be used to perform part of an
1025 operation OP on SIZE bytes. Try to use QI vector modes where
1026 possible. */
1027 static fixed_size_mode
1028 widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (unsigned int size, by_pieces_operation op)
1030 fixed_size_mode result = NARROWEST_INT_MODE;
1032 gcc_checking_assert (size > 1);
1034 /* Use QI vector only if size is wider than a WORD. */
1035 if (can_use_qi_vectors (op) && size > UNITS_PER_WORD)
1037 machine_mode mode;
1038 fixed_size_mode candidate;
1039 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode, MODE_VECTOR_INT)
1040 if (is_a<fixed_size_mode> (mode, &candidate)
1041 && GET_MODE_INNER (candidate) == QImode)
1043 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (candidate) >= size)
1044 break;
1045 if (by_pieces_mode_supported_p (candidate, op))
1046 result = candidate;
1049 if (result != NARROWEST_INT_MODE)
1050 return result;
1053 opt_scalar_int_mode tmode;
1054 scalar_int_mode mode;
1055 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (tmode, MODE_INT)
1057 mode = tmode.require ();
1058 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < size
1059 && by_pieces_mode_supported_p (mode, op))
1060 result = mode;
1063 return result;
1066 /* Determine whether an operation OP on LEN bytes with alignment ALIGN can
1067 and should be performed piecewise. */
1069 static bool
1070 can_do_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align,
1071 enum by_pieces_operation op)
1073 return targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (len, align, op,
1074 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ());
1077 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
1078 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
1079 succeed. */
1081 bool
1082 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
1084 return can_do_by_pieces (len, align, MOVE_BY_PIECES);
1087 /* Return number of insns required to perform operation OP by pieces
1088 for L bytes. ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1090 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
1091 by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
1092 unsigned int max_size, by_pieces_operation op)
1094 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1095 fixed_size_mode mode;
1097 if (targetm.overlap_op_by_pieces_p ())
1099 /* NB: Round up L and ALIGN to the widest integer mode for
1100 MAX_SIZE. */
1101 mode = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (max_size, op);
1102 gcc_assert (optab_handler (mov_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing);
1103 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT up = ROUND_UP (l, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
1104 if (up > l)
1105 l = up;
1106 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
1109 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1111 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
1113 mode = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (max_size, op);
1114 gcc_assert (optab_handler (mov_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing);
1116 unsigned int modesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1118 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1120 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_pieces = l / modesize;
1121 l %= modesize;
1122 switch (op)
1124 default:
1125 n_insns += n_pieces;
1126 break;
1128 case COMPARE_BY_PIECES:
1129 int batch = targetm.compare_by_pieces_branch_ratio (mode);
1130 int batch_ops = 4 * batch - 1;
1131 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT full = n_pieces / batch;
1132 n_insns += full * batch_ops;
1133 if (n_pieces % batch != 0)
1134 n_insns++;
1135 break;
1139 max_size = modesize;
1142 gcc_assert (!l);
1143 return n_insns;
1146 /* Used when performing piecewise block operations, holds information
1147 about one of the memory objects involved. The member functions
1148 can be used to generate code for loading from the object and
1149 updating the address when iterating. */
1151 class pieces_addr
1153 /* The object being referenced, a MEM. Can be NULL_RTX to indicate
1154 stack pushes. */
1155 rtx m_obj;
1156 /* The address of the object. Can differ from that seen in the
1157 MEM rtx if we copied the address to a register. */
1158 rtx m_addr;
1159 /* Nonzero if the address on the object has an autoincrement already,
1160 signifies whether that was an increment or decrement. */
1161 signed char m_addr_inc;
1162 /* Nonzero if we intend to use autoinc without the address already
1163 having autoinc form. We will insert add insns around each memory
1164 reference, expecting later passes to form autoinc addressing modes.
1165 The only supported options are predecrement and postincrement. */
1166 signed char m_explicit_inc;
1167 /* True if we have either of the two possible cases of using
1168 autoincrement. */
1169 bool m_auto;
1170 /* True if this is an address to be used for load operations rather
1171 than stores. */
1172 bool m_is_load;
1174 /* Optionally, a function to obtain constants for any given offset into
1175 the objects, and data associated with it. */
1176 by_pieces_constfn m_constfn;
1177 void *m_cfndata;
1178 public:
1179 pieces_addr (rtx, bool, by_pieces_constfn, void *);
1180 rtx adjust (fixed_size_mode, HOST_WIDE_INT, by_pieces_prev * = nullptr);
1181 void increment_address (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1182 void maybe_predec (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1183 void maybe_postinc (HOST_WIDE_INT);
1184 void decide_autoinc (machine_mode, bool, HOST_WIDE_INT);
1185 int get_addr_inc ()
1187 return m_addr_inc;
1191 /* Initialize a pieces_addr structure from an object OBJ. IS_LOAD is
1192 true if the operation to be performed on this object is a load
1193 rather than a store. For stores, OBJ can be NULL, in which case we
1194 assume the operation is a stack push. For loads, the optional
1195 CONSTFN and its associated CFNDATA can be used in place of the
1196 memory load. */
1198 pieces_addr::pieces_addr (rtx obj, bool is_load, by_pieces_constfn constfn,
1199 void *cfndata)
1200 : m_obj (obj), m_is_load (is_load), m_constfn (constfn), m_cfndata (cfndata)
1202 m_addr_inc = 0;
1203 m_auto = false;
1204 if (obj)
1206 rtx addr = XEXP (obj, 0);
1207 rtx_code code = GET_CODE (addr);
1208 m_addr = addr;
1209 bool dec = code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC;
1210 bool inc = code == PRE_INC || code == POST_INC;
1211 m_auto = inc || dec;
1212 if (m_auto)
1213 m_addr_inc = dec ? -1 : 1;
1215 /* While we have always looked for these codes here, the code
1216 implementing the memory operation has never handled them.
1217 Support could be added later if necessary or beneficial. */
1218 gcc_assert (code != PRE_INC && code != POST_DEC);
1220 else
1222 m_addr = NULL_RTX;
1223 if (!is_load)
1225 m_auto = true;
1226 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
1227 m_addr_inc = -1;
1228 else
1229 m_addr_inc = 1;
1231 else
1232 gcc_assert (constfn != NULL);
1234 m_explicit_inc = 0;
1235 if (constfn)
1236 gcc_assert (is_load);
1239 /* Decide whether to use autoinc for an address involved in a memory op.
1240 MODE is the mode of the accesses, REVERSE is true if we've decided to
1241 perform the operation starting from the end, and LEN is the length of
1242 the operation. Don't override an earlier decision to set m_auto. */
1244 void
1245 pieces_addr::decide_autoinc (machine_mode ARG_UNUSED (mode), bool reverse,
1246 HOST_WIDE_INT len)
1248 if (m_auto || m_obj == NULL_RTX)
1249 return;
1251 bool use_predec = (m_is_load
1252 ? USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode)
1253 : USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode));
1254 bool use_postinc = (m_is_load
1255 ? USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode)
1256 : USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode));
1257 machine_mode addr_mode = get_address_mode (m_obj);
1259 if (use_predec && reverse)
1261 m_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (addr_mode,
1262 plus_constant (addr_mode,
1263 m_addr, len));
1264 m_auto = true;
1265 m_explicit_inc = -1;
1267 else if (use_postinc && !reverse)
1269 m_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (addr_mode, m_addr);
1270 m_auto = true;
1271 m_explicit_inc = 1;
1273 else if (CONSTANT_P (m_addr))
1274 m_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (addr_mode, m_addr);
1277 /* Adjust the address to refer to the data at OFFSET in MODE. If we
1278 are using autoincrement for this address, we don't add the offset,
1279 but we still modify the MEM's properties. */
1282 pieces_addr::adjust (fixed_size_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
1283 by_pieces_prev *prev)
1285 if (m_constfn)
1286 /* Pass the previous data to m_constfn. */
1287 return m_constfn (m_cfndata, prev, offset, mode);
1288 if (m_obj == NULL_RTX)
1289 return NULL_RTX;
1290 if (m_auto)
1291 return adjust_automodify_address (m_obj, mode, m_addr, offset);
1292 else
1293 return adjust_address (m_obj, mode, offset);
1296 /* Emit an add instruction to increment the address by SIZE. */
1298 void
1299 pieces_addr::increment_address (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1301 rtx amount = gen_int_mode (size, GET_MODE (m_addr));
1302 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (m_addr, amount));
1305 /* If we are supposed to decrement the address after each access, emit code
1306 to do so now. Increment by SIZE (which has should have the correct sign
1307 already). */
1309 void
1310 pieces_addr::maybe_predec (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1312 if (m_explicit_inc >= 0)
1313 return;
1314 gcc_assert (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT);
1315 increment_address (size);
1318 /* If we are supposed to decrement the address after each access, emit code
1319 to do so now. Increment by SIZE. */
1321 void
1322 pieces_addr::maybe_postinc (HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1324 if (m_explicit_inc <= 0)
1325 return;
1326 gcc_assert (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT);
1327 increment_address (size);
1330 /* This structure is used by do_op_by_pieces to describe the operation
1331 to be performed. */
1333 class op_by_pieces_d
1335 private:
1336 fixed_size_mode get_usable_mode (fixed_size_mode, unsigned int);
1337 fixed_size_mode smallest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (unsigned int);
1339 protected:
1340 pieces_addr m_to, m_from;
1341 /* Make m_len read-only so that smallest_fixed_size_mode_for_size can
1342 use it to check the valid mode size. */
1343 const unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT m_len;
1344 HOST_WIDE_INT m_offset;
1345 unsigned int m_align;
1346 unsigned int m_max_size;
1347 bool m_reverse;
1348 /* True if this is a stack push. */
1349 bool m_push;
1350 /* True if targetm.overlap_op_by_pieces_p () returns true. */
1351 bool m_overlap_op_by_pieces;
1352 /* The type of operation that we're performing. */
1353 by_pieces_operation m_op;
1355 /* Virtual functions, overriden by derived classes for the specific
1356 operation. */
1357 virtual void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode) = 0;
1358 virtual bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int) = 0;
1359 virtual void finish_mode (machine_mode)
1363 public:
1364 op_by_pieces_d (unsigned int, rtx, bool, rtx, bool, by_pieces_constfn,
1365 void *, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int, bool,
1366 by_pieces_operation);
1367 void run ();
1370 /* The constructor for an op_by_pieces_d structure. We require two
1371 objects named TO and FROM, which are identified as loads or stores
1372 by TO_LOAD and FROM_LOAD. If FROM is a load, the optional FROM_CFN
1373 and its associated FROM_CFN_DATA can be used to replace loads with
1374 constant values. MAX_PIECES describes the maximum number of bytes
1375 at a time which can be moved efficiently. LEN describes the length
1376 of the operation. */
1378 op_by_pieces_d::op_by_pieces_d (unsigned int max_pieces, rtx to,
1379 bool to_load, rtx from, bool from_load,
1380 by_pieces_constfn from_cfn,
1381 void *from_cfn_data,
1382 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1383 unsigned int align, bool push,
1384 by_pieces_operation op)
1385 : m_to (to, to_load, NULL, NULL),
1386 m_from (from, from_load, from_cfn, from_cfn_data),
1387 m_len (len), m_max_size (max_pieces + 1),
1388 m_push (push), m_op (op)
1390 int toi = m_to.get_addr_inc ();
1391 int fromi = m_from.get_addr_inc ();
1392 if (toi >= 0 && fromi >= 0)
1393 m_reverse = false;
1394 else if (toi <= 0 && fromi <= 0)
1395 m_reverse = true;
1396 else
1397 gcc_unreachable ();
1399 m_offset = m_reverse ? len : 0;
1400 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align,
1401 from ? MEM_ALIGN (from) : align);
1403 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
1404 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
1405 and use post-increment if available. */
1406 if (by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, m_max_size, MOVE_BY_PIECES) > 2)
1408 /* Find the mode of the largest comparison. */
1409 fixed_size_mode mode
1410 = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (m_max_size, m_op);
1412 m_from.decide_autoinc (mode, m_reverse, len);
1413 m_to.decide_autoinc (mode, m_reverse, len);
1416 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1417 m_align = align;
1419 m_overlap_op_by_pieces = targetm.overlap_op_by_pieces_p ();
1422 /* This function returns the largest usable integer mode for LEN bytes
1423 whose size is no bigger than size of MODE. */
1425 fixed_size_mode
1426 op_by_pieces_d::get_usable_mode (fixed_size_mode mode, unsigned int len)
1428 unsigned int size;
1431 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1432 if (len >= size && prepare_mode (mode, m_align))
1433 break;
1434 /* widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size checks SIZE > 1. */
1435 mode = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (size, m_op);
1437 while (1);
1438 return mode;
1441 /* Return the smallest integer or QI vector mode that is not narrower
1442 than SIZE bytes. */
1444 fixed_size_mode
1445 op_by_pieces_d::smallest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (unsigned int size)
1447 /* Use QI vector only for > size of WORD. */
1448 if (can_use_qi_vectors (m_op) && size > UNITS_PER_WORD)
1450 machine_mode mode;
1451 fixed_size_mode candidate;
1452 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode, MODE_VECTOR_INT)
1453 if (is_a<fixed_size_mode> (mode, &candidate)
1454 && GET_MODE_INNER (candidate) == QImode)
1456 /* Don't return a mode wider than M_LEN. */
1457 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (candidate) > m_len)
1458 break;
1460 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (candidate) >= size
1461 && by_pieces_mode_supported_p (candidate, m_op))
1462 return candidate;
1466 return smallest_int_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT);
1469 /* This function contains the main loop used for expanding a block
1470 operation. First move what we can in the largest integer mode,
1471 then go to successively smaller modes. For every access, call
1472 GENFUN with the two operands and the EXTRA_DATA. */
1474 void
1475 op_by_pieces_d::run ()
1477 if (m_len == 0)
1478 return;
1480 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT length = m_len;
1482 /* widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size checks M_MAX_SIZE > 1. */
1483 fixed_size_mode mode
1484 = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (m_max_size, m_op);
1485 mode = get_usable_mode (mode, length);
1487 by_pieces_prev to_prev = { nullptr, mode };
1488 by_pieces_prev from_prev = { nullptr, mode };
1492 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1493 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1495 while (length >= size)
1497 if (m_reverse)
1498 m_offset -= size;
1500 to1 = m_to.adjust (mode, m_offset, &to_prev);
1501 to_prev.data = to1;
1502 to_prev.mode = mode;
1503 from1 = m_from.adjust (mode, m_offset, &from_prev);
1504 from_prev.data = from1;
1505 from_prev.mode = mode;
1507 m_to.maybe_predec (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size);
1508 m_from.maybe_predec (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size);
1510 generate (to1, from1, mode);
1512 m_to.maybe_postinc (size);
1513 m_from.maybe_postinc (size);
1515 if (!m_reverse)
1516 m_offset += size;
1518 length -= size;
1521 finish_mode (mode);
1523 if (length == 0)
1524 return;
1526 if (!m_push && m_overlap_op_by_pieces)
1528 /* NB: Generate overlapping operations if it is not a stack
1529 push since stack push must not overlap. Get the smallest
1530 fixed size mode for M_LEN bytes. */
1531 mode = smallest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (length);
1532 mode = get_usable_mode (mode, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
1533 int gap = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - length;
1534 if (gap > 0)
1536 /* If size of MODE > M_LEN, generate the last operation
1537 in MODE for the remaining bytes with ovelapping memory
1538 from the previois operation. */
1539 if (m_reverse)
1540 m_offset += gap;
1541 else
1542 m_offset -= gap;
1543 length += gap;
1546 else
1548 /* widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size checks SIZE > 1. */
1549 mode = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (size, m_op);
1550 mode = get_usable_mode (mode, length);
1553 while (1);
1556 /* Derived class from op_by_pieces_d, providing support for block move
1557 operations. */
1559 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1560 #define PUSHG_P(to) ((to) == nullptr)
1561 #else
1562 #define PUSHG_P(to) false
1563 #endif
1565 class move_by_pieces_d : public op_by_pieces_d
1567 insn_gen_fn m_gen_fun;
1568 void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode) final override;
1569 bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int) final override;
1571 public:
1572 move_by_pieces_d (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1573 unsigned int align)
1574 : op_by_pieces_d (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, to, false, from, true, NULL,
1575 NULL, len, align, PUSHG_P (to), MOVE_BY_PIECES)
1578 rtx finish_retmode (memop_ret);
1581 /* Return true if MODE can be used for a set of copies, given an
1582 alignment ALIGN. Prepare whatever data is necessary for later
1583 calls to generate. */
1585 bool
1586 move_by_pieces_d::prepare_mode (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align)
1588 insn_code icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1589 m_gen_fun = GEN_FCN (icode);
1590 return icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
1593 /* A callback used when iterating for a compare_by_pieces_operation.
1594 OP0 and OP1 are the values that have been loaded and should be
1595 compared in MODE. If OP0 is NULL, this means we should generate a
1596 push; otherwise EXTRA_DATA holds a pointer to a pointer to the insn
1597 gen function that should be used to generate the mode. */
1599 void
1600 move_by_pieces_d::generate (rtx op0, rtx op1,
1601 machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1603 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1604 if (op0 == NULL_RTX)
1606 emit_single_push_insn (mode, op1, NULL);
1607 return;
1609 #endif
1610 emit_insn (m_gen_fun (op0, op1));
1613 /* Perform the final adjustment at the end of a string to obtain the
1614 correct return value for the block operation.
1615 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1618 move_by_pieces_d::finish_retmode (memop_ret retmode)
1620 gcc_assert (!m_reverse);
1621 if (retmode == RETURN_END_MINUS_ONE)
1623 m_to.maybe_postinc (-1);
1624 --m_offset;
1626 return m_to.adjust (QImode, m_offset);
1629 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
1630 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
1632 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
1633 used to push FROM to the stack.
1635 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
1637 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1640 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1641 unsigned int align, memop_ret retmode)
1643 #ifndef PUSH_ROUNDING
1644 if (to == NULL)
1645 gcc_unreachable ();
1646 #endif
1648 move_by_pieces_d data (to, from, len, align);
1650 data.run ();
1652 if (retmode != RETURN_BEGIN)
1653 return data.finish_retmode (retmode);
1654 else
1655 return to;
1658 /* Derived class from op_by_pieces_d, providing support for block move
1659 operations. */
1661 class store_by_pieces_d : public op_by_pieces_d
1663 insn_gen_fn m_gen_fun;
1665 void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode) final override;
1666 bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int) final override;
1668 public:
1669 store_by_pieces_d (rtx to, by_pieces_constfn cfn, void *cfn_data,
1670 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align,
1671 by_pieces_operation op)
1672 : op_by_pieces_d (STORE_MAX_PIECES, to, false, NULL_RTX, true, cfn,
1673 cfn_data, len, align, false, op)
1676 rtx finish_retmode (memop_ret);
1679 /* Return true if MODE can be used for a set of stores, given an
1680 alignment ALIGN. Prepare whatever data is necessary for later
1681 calls to generate. */
1683 bool
1684 store_by_pieces_d::prepare_mode (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align)
1686 insn_code icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1687 m_gen_fun = GEN_FCN (icode);
1688 return icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode);
1691 /* A callback used when iterating for a store_by_pieces_operation.
1692 OP0 and OP1 are the values that have been loaded and should be
1693 compared in MODE. If OP0 is NULL, this means we should generate a
1694 push; otherwise EXTRA_DATA holds a pointer to a pointer to the insn
1695 gen function that should be used to generate the mode. */
1697 void
1698 store_by_pieces_d::generate (rtx op0, rtx op1, machine_mode)
1700 emit_insn (m_gen_fun (op0, op1));
1703 /* Perform the final adjustment at the end of a string to obtain the
1704 correct return value for the block operation.
1705 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1708 store_by_pieces_d::finish_retmode (memop_ret retmode)
1710 gcc_assert (!m_reverse);
1711 if (retmode == RETURN_END_MINUS_ONE)
1713 m_to.maybe_postinc (-1);
1714 --m_offset;
1716 return m_to.adjust (QImode, m_offset);
1719 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
1720 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
1721 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
1722 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
1723 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
1724 Return true if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
1726 bool
1727 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1728 by_pieces_constfn constfun,
1729 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
1731 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
1732 unsigned int max_size;
1733 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1734 enum insn_code icode;
1735 int reverse;
1736 /* cst is set but not used if LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT doesn't use it. */
1737 rtx cst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
1739 if (len == 0)
1740 return true;
1742 if (!targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (len, align,
1743 memsetp
1744 ? SET_BY_PIECES
1745 : STORE_BY_PIECES,
1746 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
1747 return false;
1749 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1751 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
1752 successively smaller modes. */
1754 for (reverse = 0;
1755 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
1756 reverse++)
1758 l = len;
1759 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
1760 while (max_size > 1 && l > 0)
1762 auto op = memsetp ? SET_BY_PIECES : STORE_BY_PIECES;
1763 auto mode = widest_fixed_size_mode_for_size (max_size, op);
1765 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1766 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
1767 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1769 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1771 while (l >= size)
1773 if (reverse)
1774 offset -= size;
1776 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, nullptr, offset, mode);
1777 /* All CONST_VECTORs can be loaded for memset since
1778 vec_duplicate_optab is a precondition to pick a
1779 vector mode for the memset expander. */
1780 if (!((memsetp && VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
1781 || targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, cst)))
1782 return false;
1784 if (!reverse)
1785 offset += size;
1787 l -= size;
1791 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1794 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
1795 gcc_assert (!l);
1798 return true;
1801 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
1802 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
1803 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
1804 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
1805 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
1806 Return value is based on RETMODE argument. */
1809 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1810 by_pieces_constfn constfun,
1811 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp,
1812 memop_ret retmode)
1814 if (len == 0)
1816 gcc_assert (retmode != RETURN_END_MINUS_ONE);
1817 return to;
1820 gcc_assert (targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p
1821 (len, align,
1822 memsetp ? SET_BY_PIECES : STORE_BY_PIECES,
1823 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()));
1825 store_by_pieces_d data (to, constfun, constfundata, len, align,
1826 memsetp ? SET_BY_PIECES : STORE_BY_PIECES);
1827 data.run ();
1829 if (retmode != RETURN_BEGIN)
1830 return data.finish_retmode (retmode);
1831 else
1832 return to;
1835 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
1836 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1838 static void
1839 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
1841 if (len == 0)
1842 return;
1844 /* Use builtin_memset_read_str to support vector mode broadcast. */
1845 char c = 0;
1846 store_by_pieces_d data (to, builtin_memset_read_str, &c, len, align,
1847 CLEAR_BY_PIECES);
1848 data.run ();
1851 /* Context used by compare_by_pieces_genfn. It stores the fail label
1852 to jump to in case of miscomparison, and for branch ratios greater than 1,
1853 it stores an accumulator and the current and maximum counts before
1854 emitting another branch. */
1856 class compare_by_pieces_d : public op_by_pieces_d
1858 rtx_code_label *m_fail_label;
1859 rtx m_accumulator;
1860 int m_count, m_batch;
1862 void generate (rtx, rtx, machine_mode) final override;
1863 bool prepare_mode (machine_mode, unsigned int) final override;
1864 void finish_mode (machine_mode) final override;
1866 public:
1867 compare_by_pieces_d (rtx op0, rtx op1, by_pieces_constfn op1_cfn,
1868 void *op1_cfn_data, HOST_WIDE_INT len, int align,
1869 rtx_code_label *fail_label)
1870 : op_by_pieces_d (COMPARE_MAX_PIECES, op0, true, op1, true, op1_cfn,
1871 op1_cfn_data, len, align, false, COMPARE_BY_PIECES)
1873 m_fail_label = fail_label;
1877 /* A callback used when iterating for a compare_by_pieces_operation.
1878 OP0 and OP1 are the values that have been loaded and should be
1879 compared in MODE. DATA holds a pointer to the compare_by_pieces_data
1880 context structure. */
1882 void
1883 compare_by_pieces_d::generate (rtx op0, rtx op1, machine_mode mode)
1885 if (m_batch > 1)
1887 rtx temp = expand_binop (mode, sub_optab, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
1888 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1889 if (m_count != 0)
1890 temp = expand_binop (mode, ior_optab, m_accumulator, temp, temp,
1891 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1892 m_accumulator = temp;
1894 if (++m_count < m_batch)
1895 return;
1897 m_count = 0;
1898 op0 = m_accumulator;
1899 op1 = const0_rtx;
1900 m_accumulator = NULL_RTX;
1902 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (op0, op1, NE, true, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL,
1903 m_fail_label, profile_probability::uninitialized ());
1906 /* Return true if MODE can be used for a set of moves and comparisons,
1907 given an alignment ALIGN. Prepare whatever data is necessary for
1908 later calls to generate. */
1910 bool
1911 compare_by_pieces_d::prepare_mode (machine_mode mode, unsigned int align)
1913 insn_code icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1914 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
1915 || align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
1916 || !can_compare_p (EQ, mode, ccp_jump))
1917 return false;
1918 m_batch = targetm.compare_by_pieces_branch_ratio (mode);
1919 if (m_batch < 0)
1920 return false;
1921 m_accumulator = NULL_RTX;
1922 m_count = 0;
1923 return true;
1926 /* Called after expanding a series of comparisons in MODE. If we have
1927 accumulated results for which we haven't emitted a branch yet, do
1928 so now. */
1930 void
1931 compare_by_pieces_d::finish_mode (machine_mode mode)
1933 if (m_accumulator != NULL_RTX)
1934 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (m_accumulator, const0_rtx, NE, true, mode,
1935 NULL_RTX, NULL, m_fail_label,
1936 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
1939 /* Generate several move instructions to compare LEN bytes from blocks
1940 ARG0 and ARG1. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
1942 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
1943 used to push FROM to the stack.
1945 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
1947 Optionally, the caller can pass a constfn and associated data in A1_CFN
1948 and A1_CFN_DATA. describing that the second operand being compared is a
1949 known constant and how to obtain its data. */
1951 static rtx
1952 compare_by_pieces (rtx arg0, rtx arg1, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
1953 rtx target, unsigned int align,
1954 by_pieces_constfn a1_cfn, void *a1_cfn_data)
1956 rtx_code_label *fail_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1957 rtx_code_label *end_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1959 if (target == NULL_RTX
1960 || !REG_P (target) || REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1961 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
1963 compare_by_pieces_d data (arg0, arg1, a1_cfn, a1_cfn_data, len, align,
1964 fail_label);
1966 data.run ();
1968 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
1969 emit_jump (end_label);
1970 emit_barrier ();
1971 emit_label (fail_label);
1972 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
1973 emit_label (end_label);
1975 return target;
1978 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1979 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1980 or with a library call.
1982 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1983 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1984 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1985 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1986 MIN_SIZE is the minimal size of block to move
1987 MAX_SIZE is the maximal size of block to move, if it cannot be represented
1988 in unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, than it is mask of all ones.
1989 CTZ_SIZE is the trailing-zeros count of SIZE; even a nonconstant SIZE is
1990 known to be a multiple of 1<<CTZ_SIZE.
1992 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1993 0 otherwise. */
1996 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1997 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
1998 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
1999 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
2000 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size,
2001 bool bail_out_libcall, bool *is_move_done,
2002 bool might_overlap, unsigned ctz_size)
2004 int may_use_call;
2005 rtx retval = 0;
2006 unsigned int align;
2008 if (is_move_done)
2009 *is_move_done = true;
2011 gcc_assert (size);
2012 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && INTVAL (size) == 0)
2013 return 0;
2015 switch (method)
2017 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
2018 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
2019 may_use_call = 1;
2020 break;
2022 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
2023 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
2025 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
2026 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
2027 NO_DEFER_POP;
2028 break;
2030 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
2031 may_use_call = 0;
2032 break;
2034 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL_RET:
2035 may_use_call = -1;
2036 break;
2038 default:
2039 gcc_unreachable ();
2042 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
2043 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
2044 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
2046 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
2047 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
2048 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
2049 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
2051 /* If source and destination are the same, no need to copy anything. */
2052 if (rtx_equal_p (x, y)
2053 && !MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
2054 && !MEM_VOLATILE_P (y))
2055 return 0;
2057 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
2058 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
2059 poly_int64 const_size;
2060 if (poly_int_rtx_p (size, &const_size))
2062 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
2063 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
2064 set_mem_size (x, const_size);
2065 set_mem_size (y, const_size);
2068 bool pieces_ok = CONST_INT_P (size)
2069 && can_move_by_pieces (INTVAL (size), align);
2070 bool pattern_ok = false;
2072 if (!pieces_ok || might_overlap)
2074 pattern_ok
2075 = emit_block_move_via_pattern (x, y, size, align,
2076 expected_align, expected_size,
2077 min_size, max_size, probable_max_size,
2078 might_overlap);
2079 if (!pattern_ok && might_overlap)
2081 /* Do not try any of the other methods below as they are not safe
2082 for overlapping moves. */
2083 *is_move_done = false;
2084 return retval;
2088 bool dynamic_direction = false;
2089 if (!pattern_ok && !pieces_ok && may_use_call
2090 && (flag_inline_stringops & (might_overlap ? ILSOP_MEMMOVE : ILSOP_MEMCPY)))
2092 may_use_call = 0;
2093 dynamic_direction = might_overlap;
2096 if (pattern_ok)
2098 else if (pieces_ok)
2099 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, RETURN_BEGIN);
2100 else if (may_use_call && !might_overlap
2101 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
2102 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
2104 if (bail_out_libcall)
2106 if (is_move_done)
2107 *is_move_done = false;
2108 return retval;
2111 if (may_use_call < 0)
2112 return pc_rtx;
2114 retval = emit_block_copy_via_libcall (x, y, size,
2115 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2117 else if (dynamic_direction)
2118 emit_block_move_via_oriented_loop (x, y, size, align, ctz_size);
2119 else if (might_overlap)
2120 *is_move_done = false;
2121 else
2122 emit_block_move_via_sized_loop (x, y, size, align, ctz_size);
2124 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
2125 OK_DEFER_POP;
2127 return retval;
2131 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
2132 unsigned int ctz_size)
2134 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max, min = 0;
2135 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
2136 min = max = UINTVAL (size);
2137 else
2138 max = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (size));
2139 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1,
2140 min, max, max,
2141 false, NULL, false, ctz_size);
2144 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
2145 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
2146 already been placed on the stack. */
2148 static bool
2149 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
2151 tree fn;
2153 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
2154 if (targetm.calls.push_argument (0))
2155 return true;
2157 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
2158 an outgoing argument. */
2159 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
2160 fn = builtin_decl_implicit (BUILT_IN_MEMCPY);
2161 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
2162 depend on its argument. */
2163 (void) fn;
2164 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
2165 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
2166 return false;
2167 #endif
2169 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
2170 argument. */
2172 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
2173 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
2174 tree arg;
2176 fn = builtin_decl_implicit (BUILT_IN_MEMCPY);
2177 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
2178 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
2180 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
2181 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
2183 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
2184 function_arg_info arg_info (mode, /*named=*/true);
2185 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, arg_info);
2186 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
2187 return false;
2188 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (args_so_far, arg_info))
2189 return false;
2190 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, arg_info);
2193 return true;
2196 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a cpymem or movmem pattern;
2197 return true if successful.
2199 X is the destination of the copy or move.
2200 Y is the source of the copy or move.
2201 SIZE is the size of the block to be moved.
2203 MIGHT_OVERLAP indicates this originated with expansion of a
2204 builtin_memmove() and the source and destination blocks may
2205 overlap.
2208 static bool
2209 emit_block_move_via_pattern (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
2210 unsigned int expected_align,
2211 HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
2212 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
2213 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
2214 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size,
2215 bool might_overlap)
2217 if (expected_align < align)
2218 expected_align = align;
2219 if (expected_size != -1)
2221 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size > probable_max_size)
2222 expected_size = probable_max_size;
2223 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size < min_size)
2224 expected_size = min_size;
2227 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
2228 temporary_volatile_ok v (true);
2230 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2231 including more than one in the machine description unless
2232 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2234 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
2235 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
2237 scalar_int_mode mode = mode_iter.require ();
2238 enum insn_code code;
2239 if (might_overlap)
2240 code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
2241 else
2242 code = direct_optab_handler (cpymem_optab, mode);
2244 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2245 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
2246 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
2247 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
2248 actual mode mask. Since SIZE is within the Pmode address
2249 space, we limit MODE to Pmode. */
2250 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
2251 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2252 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2253 || max_size <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
2254 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode)))
2256 class expand_operand ops[9];
2257 unsigned int nops;
2259 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
2260 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
2261 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
2262 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
2263 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
2264 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6 || nops == 8 || nops == 9);
2266 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], x);
2267 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], y);
2268 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
2269 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[2], size, mode, true);
2270 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2271 if (nops >= 6)
2273 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2274 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
2276 if (nops >= 8)
2278 create_integer_operand (&ops[6], min_size);
2279 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
2280 make parameter NULL. */
2281 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) max_size != -1)
2282 create_integer_operand (&ops[7], max_size);
2283 else
2284 create_fixed_operand (&ops[7], NULL);
2286 if (nops == 9)
2288 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
2289 make parameter NULL. */
2290 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) probable_max_size != -1)
2291 create_integer_operand (&ops[8], probable_max_size);
2292 else
2293 create_fixed_operand (&ops[8], NULL);
2295 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
2296 return true;
2300 return false;
2303 /* Like emit_block_move_via_loop, but choose a suitable INCR based on
2304 ALIGN and CTZ_SIZE. */
2306 static void
2307 emit_block_move_via_sized_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
2308 unsigned int align,
2309 unsigned int ctz_size)
2311 int incr = align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
2313 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
2314 ctz_size = MAX (ctz_size, (unsigned) wi::ctz (UINTVAL (size)));
2316 if (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << ctz_size < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) incr)
2317 incr = HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << ctz_size;
2319 while (incr > 1 && !can_move_by_pieces (incr, align))
2320 incr >>= 1;
2322 gcc_checking_assert (incr);
2324 return emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align, incr);
2327 /* Like emit_block_move_via_sized_loop, but besides choosing INCR so
2328 as to ensure safe moves even in case of overlap, output dynamic
2329 tests to choose between two loops, one moving downwards, another
2330 moving upwards. */
2332 static void
2333 emit_block_move_via_oriented_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
2334 unsigned int align,
2335 unsigned int ctz_size)
2337 int incr = align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
2339 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
2340 ctz_size = MAX (ctz_size, (unsigned) wi::ctz (UINTVAL (size)));
2342 if (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << ctz_size < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) incr)
2343 incr = HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << ctz_size;
2345 while (incr > 1 && !int_mode_for_size (incr, 0).exists ())
2346 incr >>= 1;
2348 gcc_checking_assert (incr);
2350 rtx_code_label *upw_label, *end_label;
2351 upw_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2352 end_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2354 rtx x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
2355 rtx y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
2356 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
2358 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x_addr);
2359 if (mode != GET_MODE (y_addr))
2361 scalar_int_mode xmode
2362 = smallest_int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode));
2363 scalar_int_mode ymode
2364 = smallest_int_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE
2365 (GET_MODE (y_addr)));
2366 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (xmode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ymode))
2367 mode = ymode;
2368 else
2369 mode = xmode;
2371 #ifndef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
2372 const int POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED = 1;
2373 #endif
2374 x_addr = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (x_addr), x_addr,
2375 POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED);
2376 y_addr = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (y_addr), y_addr,
2377 POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED);
2380 /* Test for overlap: if (x >= y || x + size <= y) goto upw_label. */
2381 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (x_addr, y_addr, GEU, NULL_RTX, mode,
2382 true, upw_label,
2383 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2384 .apply_scale (5, 10));
2385 rtx tmp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (x_addr), GET_MODE (size), size, true);
2386 tmp = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, GET_MODE (x_addr), x_addr, tmp);
2388 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (tmp, y_addr, LEU, NULL_RTX, mode,
2389 true, upw_label,
2390 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2391 .apply_scale (8, 10));
2393 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align, -incr);
2395 emit_jump (end_label);
2396 emit_label (upw_label);
2398 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align, incr);
2400 emit_label (end_label);
2403 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
2404 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden, or when
2405 inlining is required. INCR is the block size to be copied in each
2406 loop iteration. If it is negative, the absolute value is used, and
2407 the block is copied backwards. INCR must be a power of two, an
2408 exact divisor for SIZE and ALIGN, and imply a mode that can be
2409 safely copied per iteration assuming no overlap. */
2411 static void
2412 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
2413 unsigned int align, int incr)
2415 rtx_code_label *cmp_label, *top_label;
2416 rtx iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
2417 machine_mode x_addr_mode = get_address_mode (x);
2418 machine_mode y_addr_mode = get_address_mode (y);
2419 machine_mode iter_mode;
2421 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
2422 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
2423 iter_mode = word_mode;
2425 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2426 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2427 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
2429 bool downwards = incr < 0;
2430 rtx iter_init;
2431 rtx_code iter_cond;
2432 rtx iter_limit;
2433 rtx iter_incr;
2434 machine_mode move_mode;
2435 if (downwards)
2437 incr = -incr;
2438 iter_init = size;
2439 iter_cond = GEU;
2440 iter_limit = const0_rtx;
2441 iter_incr = GEN_INT (incr);
2443 else
2445 iter_init = const0_rtx;
2446 iter_cond = LTU;
2447 iter_limit = size;
2448 iter_incr = GEN_INT (incr);
2450 emit_move_insn (iter, iter_init);
2452 opt_scalar_int_mode int_move_mode
2453 = int_mode_for_size (incr * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
2454 if (!int_move_mode.exists (&move_mode)
2455 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_move_mode.require ()) != incr * BITS_PER_UNIT)
2457 move_mode = BLKmode;
2458 gcc_checking_assert (can_move_by_pieces (incr, align));
2461 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
2462 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
2463 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
2465 emit_jump (cmp_label);
2466 emit_label (top_label);
2468 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
2469 x_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
2471 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
2472 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
2473 y_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
2475 x = change_address (x, move_mode, x_addr);
2476 y = change_address (y, move_mode, y_addr);
2478 if (move_mode == BLKmode)
2480 bool done;
2481 emit_block_move_hints (x, y, iter_incr, BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL,
2482 align, incr, incr, incr, incr,
2483 false, &done, false);
2484 gcc_checking_assert (done);
2486 else
2487 emit_move_insn (x, y);
2489 if (downwards)
2490 emit_label (cmp_label);
2492 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, iter_incr, iter,
2493 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2494 if (tmp != iter)
2495 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
2497 if (!downwards)
2498 emit_label (cmp_label);
2500 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, iter_limit, iter_cond, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
2501 true, top_label,
2502 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2503 .apply_scale (9, 10));
2506 /* Expand a call to memcpy or memmove or memcmp, and return the result.
2507 TAILCALL is true if this is a tail call. */
2510 emit_block_op_via_libcall (enum built_in_function fncode, rtx dst, rtx src,
2511 rtx size, bool tailcall)
2513 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
2514 tree call_expr, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree;
2515 machine_mode size_mode;
2517 /* Since dst and src are passed to a libcall, mark the corresponding
2518 tree EXPR as addressable. */
2519 tree dst_expr = MEM_EXPR (dst);
2520 tree src_expr = MEM_EXPR (src);
2521 if (dst_expr)
2522 mark_addressable (dst_expr);
2523 if (src_expr)
2524 mark_addressable (src_expr);
2526 dst_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (dst, 0));
2527 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
2528 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
2530 src_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (src, 0));
2531 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
2532 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
2534 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2535 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2536 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2537 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2539 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions for calls to
2540 memcpy/memmove/memcmp because they can be provided by the user. */
2541 tree fn = builtin_decl_implicit (fncode);
2542 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
2543 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
2545 return expand_call (call_expr, NULL_RTX, false);
2548 /* Try to expand cmpstrn or cmpmem operation ICODE with the given operands.
2549 ARG3_TYPE is the type of ARG3_RTX. Return the result rtx on success,
2550 otherwise return null. */
2553 expand_cmpstrn_or_cmpmem (insn_code icode, rtx target, rtx arg1_rtx,
2554 rtx arg2_rtx, tree arg3_type, rtx arg3_rtx,
2555 HOST_WIDE_INT align)
2557 machine_mode insn_mode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
2559 if (target && (!REG_P (target) || HARD_REGISTER_P (target)))
2560 target = NULL_RTX;
2562 class expand_operand ops[5];
2563 create_output_operand (&ops[0], target, insn_mode);
2564 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], arg1_rtx);
2565 create_fixed_operand (&ops[2], arg2_rtx);
2566 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[3], arg3_rtx, TYPE_MODE (arg3_type),
2567 TYPE_UNSIGNED (arg3_type));
2568 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], align);
2569 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 5, ops))
2570 return ops[0].value;
2571 return NULL_RTX;
2574 /* Expand a block compare between X and Y with length LEN using the
2575 cmpmem optab, placing the result in TARGET. LEN_TYPE is the type
2576 of the expression that was used to calculate the length. ALIGN
2577 gives the known minimum common alignment. */
2579 static rtx
2580 emit_block_cmp_via_cmpmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx len, tree len_type, rtx target,
2581 unsigned align)
2583 /* Note: The cmpstrnsi pattern, if it exists, is not suitable for
2584 implementing memcmp because it will stop if it encounters two
2585 zero bytes. */
2586 insn_code icode = direct_optab_handler (cmpmem_optab, SImode);
2588 if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing)
2589 return NULL_RTX;
2591 return expand_cmpstrn_or_cmpmem (icode, target, x, y, len_type, len, align);
2594 /* Emit code to compare a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
2595 string-compare instructions, with multiple scalar instructions,
2596 or with a library call.
2598 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's. LEN is an rtx that says how long
2599 they are. LEN_TYPE is the type of the expression that was used to
2600 calculate it, and CTZ_LEN is the known trailing-zeros count of LEN,
2601 so LEN must be a multiple of 1<<CTZ_LEN even if it's not constant.
2603 If EQUALITY_ONLY is true, it means we don't have to return the tri-state
2604 value of a normal memcmp call, instead we can just compare for equality.
2605 If FORCE_LIBCALL is true, we should emit a call to memcmp rather than
2606 returning NULL_RTX.
2608 Optionally, the caller can pass a constfn and associated data in Y_CFN
2609 and Y_CFN_DATA. describing that the second operand being compared is a
2610 known constant and how to obtain its data.
2611 Return the result of the comparison, or NULL_RTX if we failed to
2612 perform the operation. */
2615 emit_block_cmp_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx len, tree len_type, rtx target,
2616 bool equality_only, by_pieces_constfn y_cfn,
2617 void *y_cfndata, unsigned ctz_len)
2619 rtx result = 0;
2621 if (CONST_INT_P (len) && INTVAL (len) == 0)
2622 return const0_rtx;
2624 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
2625 unsigned int align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
2626 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
2628 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
2629 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
2631 if (equality_only
2632 && CONST_INT_P (len)
2633 && can_do_by_pieces (INTVAL (len), align, COMPARE_BY_PIECES))
2634 result = compare_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (len), target, align,
2635 y_cfn, y_cfndata);
2636 else
2637 result = emit_block_cmp_via_cmpmem (x, y, len, len_type, target, align);
2639 if (!result && (flag_inline_stringops & ILSOP_MEMCMP))
2640 result = emit_block_cmp_via_loop (x, y, len, len_type,
2641 target, equality_only,
2642 align, ctz_len);
2644 return result;
2647 /* Like emit_block_cmp_hints, but with known alignment and no support
2648 for constats. Always expand to a loop with iterations that compare
2649 blocks of the largest compare-by-pieces size that divides both len
2650 and align, and then, if !EQUALITY_ONLY, identify the word and then
2651 the unit that first differs to return the result. */
2654 emit_block_cmp_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx len, tree len_type, rtx target,
2655 bool equality_only, unsigned align, unsigned ctz_len)
2657 unsigned incr = align / BITS_PER_UNIT;
2659 if (CONST_INT_P (len))
2660 ctz_len = MAX (ctz_len, (unsigned) wi::ctz (UINTVAL (len)));
2662 if (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << ctz_len < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) incr)
2663 incr = HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << ctz_len;
2665 while (incr > 1
2666 && !can_do_by_pieces (incr, align, COMPARE_BY_PIECES))
2667 incr >>= 1;
2669 rtx_code_label *cmp_label, *top_label, *ne_label, *res_label;
2670 rtx iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
2671 machine_mode x_addr_mode = get_address_mode (x);
2672 machine_mode y_addr_mode = get_address_mode (y);
2673 machine_mode iter_mode;
2675 iter_mode = GET_MODE (len);
2676 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
2677 iter_mode = word_mode;
2679 rtx iter_init = const0_rtx;
2680 rtx_code iter_cond = LTU;
2681 rtx_code entry_cond = GEU;
2682 rtx iter_limit = len;
2683 rtx iter_incr = GEN_INT (incr);
2684 machine_mode cmp_mode;
2686 /* We can drop the loop back edge if we know there's exactly one
2687 iteration. */
2688 top_label = (!rtx_equal_p (len, iter_incr)
2689 ? gen_label_rtx ()
2690 : NULL);
2691 /* We need not test before entering the loop if len is known
2692 nonzero. ??? This could be even stricter, testing whether a
2693 nonconstant LEN could possibly be zero. */
2694 cmp_label = (!CONSTANT_P (len) || rtx_equal_p (len, iter_init)
2695 ? gen_label_rtx ()
2696 : NULL);
2697 ne_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2698 res_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2700 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
2701 emit_move_insn (iter, iter_init);
2703 opt_scalar_int_mode int_cmp_mode
2704 = int_mode_for_size (incr * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
2705 if (!int_cmp_mode.exists (&cmp_mode)
2706 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (int_cmp_mode.require ()) != incr * BITS_PER_UNIT
2707 || !can_compare_p (NE, cmp_mode, ccp_jump))
2709 cmp_mode = BLKmode;
2710 gcc_checking_assert (incr != 1);
2713 /* Save the base addresses. */
2714 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
2715 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
2716 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
2718 if (cmp_label)
2720 if (top_label)
2721 emit_jump (cmp_label);
2722 else
2723 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, iter_limit, entry_cond,
2724 NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
2725 true, cmp_label,
2726 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2727 .apply_scale (1, 10));
2729 if (top_label)
2730 emit_label (top_label);
2732 /* Offset the base addresses by ITER. */
2733 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
2734 x_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
2736 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
2737 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
2738 y_addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
2740 x = change_address (x, cmp_mode, x_addr);
2741 y = change_address (y, cmp_mode, y_addr);
2743 /* Compare one block. */
2744 rtx part_res;
2745 if (cmp_mode == BLKmode)
2746 part_res = compare_by_pieces (x, y, incr, target, align, 0, 0);
2747 else
2748 part_res = expand_binop (cmp_mode, sub_optab, x, y, NULL_RTX,
2749 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2751 /* Stop if we found a difference. */
2752 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (part_res, GEN_INT (0), NE, NULL_RTX,
2753 GET_MODE (part_res), true, ne_label,
2754 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2755 .apply_scale (1, 10));
2757 /* Increment ITER. */
2758 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, iter_incr, iter,
2759 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2760 if (tmp != iter)
2761 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
2763 if (cmp_label)
2764 emit_label (cmp_label);
2765 /* Loop until we reach the limit. */
2767 if (top_label)
2768 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, iter_limit, iter_cond, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
2769 true, top_label,
2770 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2771 .apply_scale (9, 10));
2773 /* We got to the end without differences, so the result is zero. */
2774 if (target == NULL_RTX
2775 || !REG_P (target) || REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2776 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node));
2778 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
2779 emit_jump (res_label);
2781 emit_label (ne_label);
2783 /* Return nonzero, or pinpoint the difference to return the expected
2784 result for non-equality tests. */
2785 if (equality_only)
2786 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
2787 else
2789 if (incr > UNITS_PER_WORD)
2790 /* ??? Re-compare the block found to be different one word at a
2791 time. */
2792 part_res = emit_block_cmp_via_loop (x, y, GEN_INT (incr), len_type,
2793 target, equality_only,
2794 BITS_PER_WORD, 0);
2795 else if (incr > 1)
2796 /* ??? Re-compare the block found to be different one byte at a
2797 time. We could do better using part_res, and being careful
2798 about endianness. */
2799 part_res = emit_block_cmp_via_loop (x, y, GEN_INT (incr), len_type,
2800 target, equality_only,
2801 BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
2802 else if (known_gt (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)),
2803 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (cmp_mode)))
2804 part_res = expand_binop (GET_MODE (target), sub_optab, x, y, target,
2805 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
2806 else
2808 /* In the odd chance target is QImode, we can't count on
2809 widening subtract to capture the result of the unsigned
2810 compares. */
2811 rtx_code_label *ltu_label;
2812 ltu_label = gen_label_rtx ();
2813 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (x, y, LTU, NULL_RTX,
2814 cmp_mode, true, ltu_label,
2815 profile_probability::guessed_always ()
2816 .apply_scale (5, 10));
2818 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
2819 emit_jump (res_label);
2821 emit_label (ltu_label);
2822 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
2823 part_res = target;
2826 if (target != part_res)
2827 convert_move (target, part_res, false);
2830 emit_label (res_label);
2832 return target;
2836 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
2837 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
2839 void
2840 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, machine_mode mode)
2842 if (nregs == 0)
2843 return;
2845 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
2846 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
2848 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
2849 if (targetm.have_load_multiple ())
2851 rtx_insn *last = get_last_insn ();
2852 rtx first = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno);
2853 if (rtx_insn *pat = targetm.gen_load_multiple (first, x,
2854 GEN_INT (nregs)))
2856 emit_insn (pat);
2857 return;
2859 else
2860 delete_insns_since (last);
2863 for (int i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2864 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
2865 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
2868 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
2869 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
2871 void
2872 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
2874 if (nregs == 0)
2875 return;
2877 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
2878 if (targetm.have_store_multiple ())
2880 rtx_insn *last = get_last_insn ();
2881 rtx first = gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno);
2882 if (rtx_insn *pat = targetm.gen_store_multiple (x, first,
2883 GEN_INT (nregs)))
2885 emit_insn (pat);
2886 return;
2888 else
2889 delete_insns_since (last);
2892 for (int i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2894 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
2896 gcc_assert (tem);
2898 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
2902 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
2903 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
2904 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
2905 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
2906 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
2909 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
2911 int i, length;
2912 rtx *tmps;
2914 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
2916 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
2917 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
2919 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
2920 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
2922 if (i)
2923 tmps[0] = 0;
2925 for (; i < length; i++)
2927 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
2928 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
2930 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
2933 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
2936 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
2937 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
2938 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
2940 static void
2941 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type,
2942 poly_int64 ssize)
2944 rtx src;
2945 int start, i;
2946 machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
2948 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
2950 if (m != VOIDmode
2951 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
2952 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
2953 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
2955 scalar_int_mode imode;
2956 if (int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src)).exists (&imode))
2958 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
2959 emit_move_insn (gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src), orig_src);
2961 else
2963 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize);
2964 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
2966 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
2967 return;
2970 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
2971 both on the stack and in registers. */
2972 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
2973 start = 0;
2974 else
2975 start = 1;
2977 /* Process the pieces. */
2978 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
2980 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
2981 poly_int64 bytepos = rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
2982 poly_int64 bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2983 poly_int64 shift = 0;
2985 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct.
2986 It's the target's responsibility to make sure that the fragment
2987 cannot be strictly smaller in some cases and strictly larger
2988 in others. */
2989 gcc_checking_assert (ordered_p (bytepos + bytelen, ssize));
2990 if (known_size_p (ssize) && maybe_gt (bytepos + bytelen, ssize))
2992 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
2993 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
2994 if (
2995 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2996 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
2997 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? PAD_UPWARD : PAD_DOWNWARD)
2998 #else
2999 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
3000 #endif
3002 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
3003 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
3004 gcc_assert (maybe_gt (bytelen, 0));
3007 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
3008 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
3009 be loaded directly into the destination. */
3010 src = orig_src;
3011 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
3012 && (!REG_P (orig_src) || HARD_REGISTER_P (orig_src))
3013 && !CONSTANT_P (orig_src))
3015 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode);
3016 src = force_reg (GET_MODE (orig_src), orig_src);
3019 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
3020 if (MEM_P (src)
3021 && (! targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
3022 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
3023 && multiple_p (bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
3024 && known_eq (bytelen, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
3026 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
3027 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
3029 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
3030 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
3031 && known_eq (bytelen, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
3032 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
3033 tmps[i] = src;
3034 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
3036 poly_int64 slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
3037 poly_int64 slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
3038 unsigned int elt;
3039 poly_int64 subpos;
3041 if (can_div_trunc_p (bytepos, slen0, &elt, &subpos)
3042 && known_le (subpos + bytelen, slen0))
3044 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
3045 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
3046 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
3047 to be extracted. */
3048 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, elt);
3049 if (maybe_ne (subpos, 0)
3050 || maybe_ne (subpos + bytelen, slen0)
3051 || (!CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
3052 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode)))
3053 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3054 subpos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3055 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode, false,
3056 NULL);
3058 else
3060 rtx mem;
3062 gcc_assert (known_eq (bytepos, 0));
3063 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen);
3064 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
3065 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3066 0, 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode, false,
3067 NULL);
3070 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
3071 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
3072 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE (dst), bytepos);
3073 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
3075 if (known_eq (bytelen, ssize))
3076 tmps[i] = src;
3077 else
3079 rtx first, second;
3081 /* TODO: const_wide_int can have sizes other than this... */
3082 gcc_assert (known_eq (2 * bytelen, ssize));
3083 split_double (src, &first, &second);
3084 if (i)
3085 tmps[i] = second;
3086 else
3087 tmps[i] = first;
3090 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
3091 tmps[i] = src;
3092 else
3093 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3094 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
3095 mode, mode, false, NULL);
3097 if (maybe_ne (shift, 0))
3098 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
3099 shift, tmps[i], 0);
3103 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
3104 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
3105 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
3106 if not known. */
3108 void
3109 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, poly_int64 ssize)
3111 rtx *tmps;
3112 int i;
3114 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
3115 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
3117 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
3118 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
3120 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
3121 if (d == NULL)
3122 continue;
3123 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
3127 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
3128 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
3129 in the right place. */
3132 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, poly_int64 ssize)
3134 rtvec vec;
3135 int i;
3137 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
3138 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
3140 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
3141 with the computed values. */
3142 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
3144 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
3145 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
3147 if (d)
3149 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
3150 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
3152 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
3155 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
3158 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
3159 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
3161 void
3162 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
3164 int i;
3166 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
3167 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
3168 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
3170 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
3171 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
3172 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
3173 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
3176 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
3179 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
3181 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
3182 int i;
3184 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
3186 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
3187 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
3189 if (d)
3190 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
3191 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
3194 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
3197 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
3198 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
3199 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
3200 known. */
3202 void
3203 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3204 poly_int64 ssize)
3206 rtx *tmps, dst;
3207 int start, finish, i;
3208 machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
3210 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
3212 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
3213 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
3215 scalar_int_mode imode;
3216 if (int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst)).exists (&imode))
3218 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
3219 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
3220 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
3222 else
3224 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize);
3225 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
3227 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
3228 return;
3231 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
3232 both on the stack and in registers. */
3233 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
3234 start = 0;
3235 else
3236 start = 1;
3237 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
3239 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
3241 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
3242 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
3244 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
3245 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3247 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
3248 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
3250 else
3251 tmps[i] = reg;
3254 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
3255 from strange tricks we might play. */
3256 dst = orig_dst;
3257 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
3259 rtx temp;
3261 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
3262 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
3263 so no action is necessary. */
3264 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
3265 return;
3267 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
3268 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
3269 the temporary. */
3270 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize);
3271 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
3272 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
3273 return;
3275 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
3277 machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
3278 machine_mode inner;
3279 poly_int64 bytepos;
3280 bool done = false;
3281 rtx temp;
3283 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3284 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
3286 /* Make life a bit easier for combine: if the first element of the
3287 vector is the low part of the destination mode, use a paradoxical
3288 subreg to initialize the destination. */
3289 if (start < finish)
3291 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
3292 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
3293 if (known_eq (rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)),
3294 bytepos))
3296 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start], inner, 0);
3297 if (temp)
3299 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
3300 done = true;
3301 start++;
3306 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
3307 if (!done
3308 && start < finish - 1)
3310 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
3311 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
3312 if (known_eq (rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0,
3313 finish - 1), 1)),
3314 bytepos))
3316 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1], inner, 0);
3317 if (temp)
3319 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
3320 done = true;
3321 finish--;
3326 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
3327 if (!done)
3328 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
3331 /* Process the pieces. */
3332 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
3334 poly_int64 bytepos = rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
3335 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
3336 poly_int64 bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3337 poly_uint64 adj_bytelen;
3338 rtx dest = dst;
3340 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct.
3341 It's the target's responsibility to make sure that the fragment
3342 cannot be strictly smaller in some cases and strictly larger
3343 in others. */
3344 gcc_checking_assert (ordered_p (bytepos + bytelen, ssize));
3345 if (known_size_p (ssize) && maybe_gt (bytepos + bytelen, ssize))
3346 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
3347 else
3348 adj_bytelen = bytelen;
3350 /* Deal with destination CONCATs by either storing into one of the parts
3351 or doing a copy after storing into a register or stack temporary. */
3352 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
3354 if (known_le (bytepos + adj_bytelen,
3355 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)))))
3356 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
3358 else if (known_ge (bytepos, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)))))
3360 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
3361 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
3364 else
3366 machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
3367 machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
3368 scalar_int_mode dest_imode;
3370 gcc_assert (known_eq (bytepos, 0) && XVECLEN (src, 0));
3372 /* If the source is a single scalar integer register, and the
3373 destination has a complex mode for which a same-sized integer
3374 mode exists, then we can take the left-justified part of the
3375 source in the complex mode. */
3376 if (finish == start + 1
3377 && REG_P (tmps[i])
3378 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (tmp_mode)
3379 && COMPLEX_MODE_P (dest_mode)
3380 && int_mode_for_mode (dest_mode).exists (&dest_imode))
3382 const scalar_int_mode tmp_imode
3383 = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (tmp_mode);
3385 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (dest_imode)
3386 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmp_imode))
3388 dest = gen_reg_rtx (dest_imode);
3389 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3390 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, tmp_mode, tmps[i],
3391 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmp_imode)
3392 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (dest_imode),
3393 NULL_RTX, 1);
3394 emit_move_insn (dest, gen_lowpart (dest_imode, tmps[i]));
3395 dst = gen_lowpart (dest_mode, dest);
3397 else
3398 dst = gen_lowpart (dest_mode, tmps[i]);
3401 /* Otherwise spill the source onto the stack using the more
3402 aligned of the two modes. */
3403 else if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
3404 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
3406 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
3407 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode));
3408 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, tmp_mode, bytepos),
3409 tmps[i]);
3410 dst = dest;
3413 else
3415 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
3416 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode));
3417 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
3418 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
3421 break;
3425 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
3426 if (known_size_p (ssize) && maybe_gt (bytepos + bytelen, ssize))
3428 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
3429 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
3430 if (
3431 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
3432 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
3433 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? PAD_UPWARD : PAD_DOWNWARD)
3434 #else
3435 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
3436 #endif
3439 poly_int64 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
3440 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
3441 shift, tmps[i], 0);
3444 /* Make sure not to write past the end of the struct. */
3445 store_bit_field (dest,
3446 adj_bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3447 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, ssize * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1,
3448 VOIDmode, tmps[i], false, false);
3451 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
3452 else if (MEM_P (dest)
3453 && (!targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
3454 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
3455 && multiple_p (bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3456 GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
3457 && known_eq (bytelen, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
3458 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
3460 else
3461 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
3462 0, 0, mode, tmps[i], false, false);
3465 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
3466 if (orig_dst != dst)
3467 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
3470 /* Return a form of X that does not use a PARALLEL. TYPE is the type
3471 of the value stored in X. */
3474 maybe_emit_group_store (rtx x, tree type)
3476 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
3477 gcc_checking_assert (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode || GET_MODE (x) == mode);
3478 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
3480 rtx result = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
3481 emit_group_store (result, x, type, int_size_in_bytes (type));
3482 return result;
3484 return x;
3487 /* Copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a register SRCREG into TARGET.
3489 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
3491 static void
3492 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx target, rtx srcreg, tree type)
3494 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
3495 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
3496 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
3497 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
3498 /* No current ABI uses variable-sized modes to pass a BLKmnode type. */
3499 fixed_size_mode mode = as_a <fixed_size_mode> (GET_MODE (srcreg));
3500 fixed_size_mode tmode = as_a <fixed_size_mode> (GET_MODE (target));
3501 fixed_size_mode copy_mode;
3503 /* BLKmode registers created in the back-end shouldn't have survived. */
3504 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3506 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
3507 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
3508 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
3510 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
3511 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
3512 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
3513 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
3514 end of the register. */
3515 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
3516 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
3517 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
3518 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
3519 padding_correction
3520 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
3522 /* We can use a single move if we have an exact mode for the size. */
3523 else if (MEM_P (target)
3524 && (!targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target))
3525 || MEM_ALIGN (target) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
3526 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
3528 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (target, mode, 0), srcreg);
3529 return;
3532 /* And if we additionally have the same mode for a register. */
3533 else if (REG_P (target)
3534 && GET_MODE (target) == mode
3535 && bytes == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
3537 emit_move_insn (target, srcreg);
3538 return;
3541 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
3542 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
3543 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
3545 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
3546 mode = word_mode;
3549 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
3550 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
3551 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
3552 how it is computed.
3554 If the target lives in register, make sure not to select a copy mode
3555 larger than the mode of the register.
3557 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
3558 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
3559 time. */
3561 copy_mode = word_mode;
3562 if (MEM_P (target))
3564 opt_scalar_int_mode mem_mode = int_mode_for_size (bitsize, 1);
3565 if (mem_mode.exists ())
3566 copy_mode = mem_mode.require ();
3568 else if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
3569 copy_mode = tmode;
3571 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
3572 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
3573 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
3575 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
3576 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
3577 (the first time through). */
3578 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
3579 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, mode);
3581 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
3582 a word boundary. */
3583 if (REG_P (target) && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
3584 dst = target;
3585 else if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
3586 dst = operand_subword (target, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, tmode);
3588 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
3589 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
3590 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 0, 0, copy_mode,
3591 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
3592 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
3593 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode,
3594 false, NULL),
3595 false, false);
3599 /* Copy BLKmode value SRC into a register of mode MODE_IN. Return the
3600 register if it contains any data, otherwise return null.
3602 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
3605 copy_blkmode_to_reg (machine_mode mode_in, tree src)
3607 int i, n_regs;
3608 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0, bytes;
3609 unsigned int bitsize;
3610 rtx *dst_words, dst, x, src_word = NULL_RTX, dst_word = NULL_RTX;
3611 /* No current ABI uses variable-sized modes to pass a BLKmnode type. */
3612 fixed_size_mode mode = as_a <fixed_size_mode> (mode_in);
3613 fixed_size_mode dst_mode;
3614 scalar_int_mode min_mode;
3616 gcc_assert (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) == BLKmode);
3618 x = expand_normal (src);
3620 bytes = arg_int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (src));
3621 if (bytes == 0)
3622 return NULL_RTX;
3624 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see
3625 whether the register value should be padded on the left or on
3626 the right. Set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of padding
3627 bits needed on the left side.
3629 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
3630 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
3631 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
3632 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
3633 end of the register. */
3634 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
3635 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (src))
3636 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
3637 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
3638 padding_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
3639 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
3641 n_regs = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3642 dst_words = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, n_regs);
3643 bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (src)), BITS_PER_WORD);
3644 min_mode = smallest_int_mode_for_size (bitsize);
3646 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. */
3647 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
3648 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
3649 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
3651 /* We need a new destination pseudo each time xbitpos is
3652 on a word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
3653 (the first time through). */
3654 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
3655 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
3657 /* Generate an appropriate register. */
3658 dst_word = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
3659 dst_words[xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD] = dst_word;
3661 /* Clear the destination before we move anything into it. */
3662 emit_move_insn (dst_word, CONST0_RTX (word_mode));
3665 /* Find the largest integer mode that can be used to copy all or as
3666 many bits as possible of the structure if the target supports larger
3667 copies. There are too many corner cases here w.r.t to alignments on
3668 the read/writes. So if there is any padding just use single byte
3669 operations. */
3670 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
3671 if (padding_correction == 0 && !STRICT_ALIGNMENT)
3673 FOR_EACH_MODE_FROM (mode_iter, min_mode)
3675 unsigned int msize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode_iter.require ());
3676 if (msize <= ((bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT) - bitpos)
3677 && msize <= BITS_PER_WORD)
3678 bitsize = msize;
3679 else
3680 break;
3684 /* We need a new source operand each time bitpos is on a word
3685 boundary. */
3686 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
3687 src_word = operand_subword_force (x, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, BLKmode);
3689 /* Use bitpos for the source extraction (left justified) and
3690 xbitpos for the destination store (right justified). */
3691 store_bit_field (dst_word, bitsize, xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD,
3692 0, 0, word_mode,
3693 extract_bit_field (src_word, bitsize,
3694 bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
3695 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode,
3696 false, NULL),
3697 false, false);
3700 if (mode == BLKmode)
3702 /* Find the smallest integer mode large enough to hold the
3703 entire structure. */
3704 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
3705 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
3706 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode_iter.require ()) >= bytes)
3707 break;
3709 /* A suitable mode should have been found. */
3710 mode = mode_iter.require ();
3713 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
3714 dst_mode = word_mode;
3715 else
3716 dst_mode = mode;
3717 dst = gen_reg_rtx (dst_mode);
3719 for (i = 0; i < n_regs; i++)
3720 emit_move_insn (operand_subword (dst, i, 0, dst_mode), dst_words[i]);
3722 if (mode != dst_mode)
3723 dst = gen_lowpart (mode, dst);
3725 return dst;
3728 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
3729 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
3731 void
3732 use_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, machine_mode mode)
3734 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg));
3736 if (!HARD_REGISTER_P (reg))
3737 return;
3739 *call_fusage
3740 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
3743 /* Add a CLOBBER expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
3744 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
3746 void
3747 clobber_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, machine_mode mode)
3749 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3751 *call_fusage
3752 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
3755 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
3756 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
3758 void
3759 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
3761 int i;
3763 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
3765 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
3766 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
3769 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
3770 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
3771 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
3773 void
3774 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
3776 int i;
3778 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
3780 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
3782 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
3783 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
3784 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
3785 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
3786 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
3790 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
3791 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
3792 NULL otherwise. */
3794 static gimple *
3795 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
3797 gimple *def_stmt;
3799 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
3800 return NULL;
3802 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
3803 if (!def_stmt
3804 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
3805 return NULL;
3807 return def_stmt;
3810 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
3811 assigment and the class of the expresion on the RHS is CLASS. Return
3812 NULL otherwise. */
3814 static gimple *
3815 get_def_for_expr_class (tree name, enum tree_code_class tclass)
3817 gimple *def_stmt;
3819 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
3820 return NULL;
3822 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
3823 if (!def_stmt
3824 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt)) != tclass)
3825 return NULL;
3827 return def_stmt;
3830 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
3831 its length in bytes. */
3834 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
3835 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
3836 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
3837 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
3838 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size,
3839 unsigned ctz_size)
3841 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
3842 unsigned int align;
3844 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
3846 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
3847 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
3848 poly_int64 size_val;
3849 if (mode != BLKmode
3850 && poly_int_rtx_p (size, &size_val)
3851 && known_eq (size_val, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)))
3853 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
3854 if (zero != NULL)
3856 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
3857 return NULL;
3860 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3862 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
3863 if (zero != NULL)
3865 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0, true);
3866 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1, false);
3867 return NULL;
3872 if (size == const0_rtx)
3873 return NULL;
3875 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
3877 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
3878 && targetm.use_by_pieces_infrastructure_p (INTVAL (size), align,
3879 CLEAR_BY_PIECES,
3880 optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
3881 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
3882 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
3883 expected_align, expected_size,
3884 min_size, max_size, probable_max_size))
3886 else if (try_store_by_multiple_pieces (object, size, ctz_size,
3887 min_size, max_size,
3888 NULL_RTX, 0, align))
3890 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
3891 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
3892 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
3893 else
3894 gcc_unreachable ();
3896 return NULL;
3900 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
3902 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max, min = 0;
3903 if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
3904 min = max = UINTVAL (size);
3905 else
3906 max = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (size));
3907 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1, min, max, max, 0);
3911 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
3912 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
3915 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
3917 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
3918 machine_mode size_mode;
3920 object = copy_addr_to_reg (XEXP (object, 0));
3921 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
3923 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
3924 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
3925 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
3927 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
3928 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
3929 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
3930 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
3932 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions for calls to
3933 memset because it can be provided by the user. */
3934 fn = builtin_decl_implicit (BUILT_IN_MEMSET);
3935 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
3936 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
3938 return expand_call (call_expr, NULL_RTX, false);
3941 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
3943 bool
3944 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
3945 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size,
3946 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT min_size,
3947 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT max_size,
3948 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT probable_max_size)
3950 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
3951 including more than one in the machine description unless
3952 the more limited one has some advantage. */
3954 if (expected_align < align)
3955 expected_align = align;
3956 if (expected_size != -1)
3958 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size > max_size)
3959 expected_size = max_size;
3960 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)expected_size < min_size)
3961 expected_size = min_size;
3964 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
3965 FOR_EACH_MODE_IN_CLASS (mode_iter, MODE_INT)
3967 scalar_int_mode mode = mode_iter.require ();
3968 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
3970 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
3971 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
3972 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
3973 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
3974 actual mode mask. Since SIZE is within the Pmode address
3975 space, we limit MODE to Pmode. */
3976 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
3977 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
3978 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
3979 || max_size <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)
3980 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (Pmode)))
3982 class expand_operand ops[9];
3983 unsigned int nops;
3985 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
3986 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6 || nops == 8 || nops == 9);
3988 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], object);
3989 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
3990 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[1], size, mode, true);
3991 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[2], val, byte_mode, true);
3992 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3993 if (nops >= 6)
3995 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3996 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
3998 if (nops >= 8)
4000 create_integer_operand (&ops[6], min_size);
4001 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
4002 make parameter NULL. */
4003 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) max_size != -1)
4004 create_integer_operand (&ops[7], max_size);
4005 else
4006 create_fixed_operand (&ops[7], NULL);
4008 if (nops == 9)
4010 /* If we cannot represent the maximal size,
4011 make parameter NULL. */
4012 if ((HOST_WIDE_INT) probable_max_size != -1)
4013 create_integer_operand (&ops[8], probable_max_size);
4014 else
4015 create_fixed_operand (&ops[8], NULL);
4017 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
4018 return true;
4022 return false;
4026 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
4027 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true.
4028 If UNDEFINED_P then the value in CPLX is currently undefined. */
4030 void
4031 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p, bool undefined_p)
4033 machine_mode cmode;
4034 scalar_mode imode;
4035 unsigned ibitsize;
4037 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
4039 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
4040 return;
4043 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
4044 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
4045 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
4047 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
4048 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
4049 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
4050 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
4051 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
4052 if (MEM_P (cplx))
4054 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
4055 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
4056 val);
4057 return;
4060 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
4061 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
4062 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
4063 correspond to TCmode. */
4064 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4065 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
4066 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
4067 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
4068 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
4069 || (REG_P (cplx)
4070 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4071 && REG_NREGS (cplx) % 2 == 0))
4073 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
4074 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
4075 if (part)
4077 emit_move_insn (part, val);
4078 return;
4080 else
4081 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
4082 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
4085 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, 0, 0, imode, val,
4086 false, undefined_p);
4089 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
4090 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
4093 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
4095 machine_mode cmode;
4096 scalar_mode imode;
4097 unsigned ibitsize;
4099 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
4100 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
4102 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
4103 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
4104 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
4106 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
4107 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
4109 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
4110 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
4112 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
4113 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
4114 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4118 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
4119 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
4120 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
4121 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
4122 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
4123 if (MEM_P (cplx))
4124 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
4125 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
4127 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
4128 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
4129 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
4130 correspond to TCmode. */
4131 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4132 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
4133 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
4134 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
4135 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
4136 || (REG_P (cplx)
4137 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4138 && REG_NREGS (cplx) % 2 == 0))
4140 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
4141 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
4142 if (ret)
4143 return ret;
4144 else
4145 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
4146 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
4149 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
4150 true, NULL_RTX, imode, imode, false, NULL);
4153 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
4154 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
4155 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
4156 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
4158 static rtx
4159 emit_move_change_mode (machine_mode new_mode,
4160 machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
4162 rtx ret;
4164 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
4166 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
4167 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
4169 else if (MEM_P (x))
4171 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
4172 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
4173 if (reload_in_progress)
4175 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
4176 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
4177 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
4178 copy_replacements (x, ret);
4180 else
4181 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
4183 else
4185 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
4186 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
4187 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
4188 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
4189 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
4190 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
4191 if (force)
4192 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
4193 else
4194 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
4197 return ret;
4200 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
4201 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
4202 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
4204 static rtx_insn *
4205 emit_move_via_integer (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
4207 scalar_int_mode imode;
4208 enum insn_code code;
4210 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
4211 if (!int_mode_for_mode (mode).exists (&imode))
4212 return NULL;
4214 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
4215 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
4216 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
4217 return NULL;
4219 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
4220 if (x == NULL_RTX)
4221 return NULL;
4222 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
4223 if (y == NULL_RTX)
4224 return NULL;
4225 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
4228 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
4229 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
4232 emit_move_resolve_push (machine_mode mode, rtx x)
4234 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
4235 rtx temp;
4237 poly_int64 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
4238 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4239 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
4240 #endif
4241 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
4242 adjust = -adjust;
4243 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
4245 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
4247 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
4248 poly_int64 val = rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (expr, 1));
4249 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
4250 val = -val;
4251 gcc_assert (known_eq (adjust, val) || known_eq (adjust, -val));
4252 adjust = val;
4255 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
4256 stack_pointer_delta. */
4257 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
4258 gen_int_mode (adjust, Pmode), stack_pointer_rtx,
4259 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4260 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
4261 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
4263 switch (code)
4265 case PRE_INC:
4266 case PRE_DEC:
4267 case PRE_MODIFY:
4268 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
4269 break;
4270 case POST_INC:
4271 case POST_DEC:
4272 case POST_MODIFY:
4273 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
4274 break;
4275 default:
4276 gcc_unreachable ();
4279 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
4282 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
4283 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
4284 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
4286 rtx_insn *
4287 emit_move_complex_push (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
4289 scalar_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
4290 bool imag_first;
4292 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4293 poly_int64 submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
4295 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
4296 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
4297 if (maybe_ne (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize), submodesize))
4299 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
4300 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
4302 #endif
4304 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
4305 regardless of machine's endianness. */
4306 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
4308 case PRE_DEC:
4309 case POST_DEC:
4310 imag_first = true;
4311 break;
4312 case PRE_INC:
4313 case POST_INC:
4314 imag_first = false;
4315 break;
4316 default:
4317 gcc_unreachable ();
4320 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
4321 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
4322 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
4323 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
4326 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
4327 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
4329 rtx_insn *
4330 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
4332 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
4333 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
4334 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
4335 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
4336 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
4337 emit_clobber (x);
4339 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false, true);
4340 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true, false);
4342 return get_last_insn ();
4345 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
4346 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
4348 static rtx_insn *
4349 emit_move_complex (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
4351 bool try_int;
4353 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
4354 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
4355 if (push_operand (x, mode))
4356 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
4358 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once, except
4359 for floating point where we favor moving as parts if this is easy. */
4360 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
4361 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing
4362 && !(REG_P (x)
4363 && HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
4364 && REG_NREGS (x) == 1)
4365 && !(REG_P (y)
4366 && HARD_REGISTER_P (y)
4367 && REG_NREGS (y) == 1))
4368 try_int = false;
4369 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
4370 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
4371 try_int = false;
4372 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
4373 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
4374 try_int = true;
4375 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
4376 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
4377 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
4378 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
4379 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
4380 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
4381 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
4382 try_int = true;
4383 else
4384 try_int = false;
4386 if (try_int)
4388 rtx_insn *ret;
4390 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
4391 existing block move logic. But use normal expansion if optimizing
4392 for size. */
4393 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
4395 emit_block_move (x, y, gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), Pmode),
4396 (optimize_insn_for_speed_p()
4397 ? BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
4398 return get_last_insn ();
4401 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
4402 if (ret)
4403 return ret;
4406 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
4409 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
4410 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
4412 static rtx_insn *
4413 emit_move_ccmode (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
4415 rtx_insn *ret;
4417 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
4418 if (mode != CCmode)
4420 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
4421 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4423 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
4424 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
4425 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
4429 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
4430 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
4431 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
4432 return ret;
4435 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
4436 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
4438 static bool
4439 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
4441 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
4442 return false;
4443 machine_mode innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
4444 poly_int64 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + subreg_memory_offset (op);
4445 return (known_ge (offset, GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode))
4446 || known_le (offset, -UNITS_PER_WORD));
4449 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
4450 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
4451 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
4452 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
4454 static rtx_insn *
4455 emit_move_multi_word (machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
4457 rtx_insn *last_insn = 0;
4458 rtx_insn *seq;
4459 rtx inner;
4460 bool need_clobber;
4461 int i, mode_size;
4463 /* This function can only handle cases where the number of words is
4464 known at compile time. */
4465 mode_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).to_constant ();
4466 gcc_assert (mode_size >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
4468 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
4469 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
4470 if (push_operand (x, mode))
4471 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
4473 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
4474 is scheduled for replacement. */
4475 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
4476 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
4477 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
4478 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
4479 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
4480 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
4482 start_sequence ();
4484 need_clobber = false;
4485 for (i = 0; i < CEIL (mode_size, UNITS_PER_WORD); i++)
4487 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would go entirely
4488 to the non-existing bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
4489 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (x, i))
4490 continue;
4492 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
4493 rtx ypart;
4495 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
4496 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
4497 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
4498 continue;
4500 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
4502 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
4503 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
4504 be able to get a part of Y. */
4505 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
4507 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
4508 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
4510 else if (ypart == 0)
4511 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
4513 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
4515 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
4517 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
4520 seq = get_insns ();
4521 end_sequence ();
4523 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
4524 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
4525 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
4526 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
4527 if (x != y
4528 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
4529 && need_clobber != 0)
4530 emit_clobber (x);
4532 emit_insn (seq);
4534 return last_insn;
4537 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
4538 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
4539 are basically valid. */
4541 rtx_insn *
4542 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
4544 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4545 enum insn_code code;
4547 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
4549 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
4550 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4551 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
4553 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
4554 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
4555 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
4557 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
4558 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
4560 rtx_insn *result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
4562 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
4563 if (result)
4564 return result;
4565 else
4566 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
4569 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
4570 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
4572 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
4573 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
4574 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
4575 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
4576 if (!CONSTANT_P (y)
4577 || known_le (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))
4579 rtx_insn *ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, lra_in_progress);
4581 if (ret)
4583 if (! lra_in_progress || recog (PATTERN (ret), ret, 0) >= 0)
4584 return ret;
4588 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
4591 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
4592 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
4593 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
4594 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
4596 Return the last instruction emitted. */
4598 rtx_insn *
4599 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
4601 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4602 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
4603 rtx_insn *last_insn;
4604 rtx set;
4606 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
4607 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
4609 /* If we have a copy that looks like one of the following patterns:
4610 (set (subreg:M1 (reg:M2 ...)) (subreg:M1 (reg:M2 ...)))
4611 (set (subreg:M1 (reg:M2 ...)) (mem:M1 ADDR))
4612 (set (mem:M1 ADDR) (subreg:M1 (reg:M2 ...)))
4613 (set (subreg:M1 (reg:M2 ...)) (constant C))
4614 where mode M1 is equal in size to M2, try to detect whether the
4615 mode change involves an implicit round trip through memory.
4616 If so, see if we can avoid that by removing the subregs and
4617 doing the move in mode M2 instead. */
4619 rtx x_inner = NULL_RTX;
4620 rtx y_inner = NULL_RTX;
4622 auto candidate_subreg_p = [&](rtx subreg) {
4623 return (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (subreg))
4624 && known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg))),
4625 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (subreg)))
4626 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg)))
4627 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
4630 auto candidate_mem_p = [&](machine_mode innermode, rtx mem) {
4631 return (!targetm.can_change_mode_class (innermode, GET_MODE (mem), ALL_REGS)
4632 && !push_operand (mem, GET_MODE (mem))
4633 /* Not a candiate if innermode requires too much alignment. */
4634 && (MEM_ALIGN (mem) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (innermode)
4635 || targetm.slow_unaligned_access (GET_MODE (mem),
4636 MEM_ALIGN (mem))
4637 || !targetm.slow_unaligned_access (innermode,
4638 MEM_ALIGN (mem))));
4641 if (SUBREG_P (x) && candidate_subreg_p (x))
4642 x_inner = SUBREG_REG (x);
4644 if (SUBREG_P (y) && candidate_subreg_p (y))
4645 y_inner = SUBREG_REG (y);
4647 if (x_inner != NULL_RTX
4648 && y_inner != NULL_RTX
4649 && GET_MODE (x_inner) == GET_MODE (y_inner)
4650 && !targetm.can_change_mode_class (GET_MODE (x_inner), mode, ALL_REGS))
4652 x = x_inner;
4653 y = y_inner;
4654 mode = GET_MODE (x_inner);
4656 else if (x_inner != NULL_RTX
4657 && MEM_P (y)
4658 && candidate_mem_p (GET_MODE (x_inner), y))
4660 x = x_inner;
4661 y = adjust_address (y, GET_MODE (x_inner), 0);
4662 mode = GET_MODE (x_inner);
4664 else if (y_inner != NULL_RTX
4665 && MEM_P (x)
4666 && candidate_mem_p (GET_MODE (y_inner), x))
4668 x = adjust_address (x, GET_MODE (y_inner), 0);
4669 y = y_inner;
4670 mode = GET_MODE (y_inner);
4672 else if (x_inner != NULL_RTX
4673 && CONSTANT_P (y)
4674 && !targetm.can_change_mode_class (GET_MODE (x_inner),
4675 mode, ALL_REGS)
4676 && (y_inner = simplify_subreg (GET_MODE (x_inner), y, mode, 0)))
4678 x = x_inner;
4679 y = y_inner;
4680 mode = GET_MODE (x_inner);
4683 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
4685 if (optimize
4686 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
4687 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
4688 return last_insn;
4690 y_cst = y;
4692 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, y))
4694 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
4696 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
4697 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
4698 of the non-legitimate constant. */
4699 if (!y)
4700 y = y_cst;
4701 else
4702 y = use_anchored_address (y);
4706 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
4707 for the machine. */
4708 if (MEM_P (x)
4709 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
4710 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
4711 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
4712 x = validize_mem (x);
4714 if (MEM_P (y)
4715 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
4716 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
4717 y = validize_mem (y);
4719 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
4721 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
4723 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
4724 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
4725 && SET_DEST (set) == x
4726 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
4727 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (y_cst));
4729 return last_insn;
4732 /* Generate the body of an instruction to copy Y into X.
4733 It may be a list of insns, if one insn isn't enough. */
4735 rtx_insn *
4736 gen_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
4738 rtx_insn *seq;
4740 start_sequence ();
4741 emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
4742 seq = get_insns ();
4743 end_sequence ();
4744 return seq;
4747 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
4748 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
4749 move as an extension. */
4751 static rtx_insn *
4752 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
4754 machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
4755 machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
4756 machine_mode srcmode;
4757 const REAL_VALUE_TYPE *r;
4758 int oldcost, newcost;
4759 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
4761 r = CONST_DOUBLE_REAL_VALUE (y);
4763 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (dstmode, y))
4764 oldcost = set_src_cost (y, orig_srcmode, speed);
4765 else
4766 oldcost = set_src_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), dstmode, speed);
4768 FOR_EACH_MODE_UNTIL (srcmode, orig_srcmode)
4770 enum insn_code ic;
4771 rtx trunc_y;
4772 rtx_insn *last_insn;
4774 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
4775 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
4776 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
4777 continue;
4779 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
4780 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, r))
4781 continue;
4783 trunc_y = const_double_from_real_value (*r, srcmode);
4785 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (srcmode, trunc_y))
4787 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
4788 the extension. */
4789 if (!insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, trunc_y))
4790 continue;
4791 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
4792 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
4793 dstmode, speed);
4794 if (oldcost < newcost)
4795 continue;
4797 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
4799 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
4800 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
4801 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
4802 dstmode, speed);
4803 if (oldcost < newcost)
4804 continue;
4805 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
4807 else
4808 continue;
4810 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
4811 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
4812 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
4813 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
4815 /* If x is a hard register, perform the extension into a pseudo,
4816 so that e.g. stack realignment code is aware of it. */
4817 rtx target = x;
4818 if (REG_P (x) && HARD_REGISTER_P (x))
4819 target = gen_reg_rtx (dstmode);
4821 emit_unop_insn (ic, target, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
4822 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
4824 if (REG_P (target))
4825 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
4827 if (target != x)
4828 return emit_move_insn (x, target);
4829 return last_insn;
4832 return NULL;
4835 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
4837 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
4838 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
4839 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
4841 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
4842 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
4843 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
4846 push_block (rtx size, poly_int64 extra, int below)
4848 rtx temp;
4850 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
4851 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
4852 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (Pmode, size, extra));
4853 else if (REG_P (size) && known_eq (extra, 0))
4854 anti_adjust_stack (size);
4855 else
4857 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
4858 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0))
4859 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp,
4860 gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode),
4861 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4862 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
4865 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
4867 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
4868 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0) && below)
4869 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, temp, extra);
4871 else
4873 poly_int64 csize;
4874 if (poly_int_rtx_p (size, &csize))
4875 temp = plus_constant (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
4876 -csize - (below ? 0 : extra));
4877 else if (maybe_ne (extra, 0) && !below)
4878 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
4879 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (Pmode, size,
4880 extra)));
4881 else
4882 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
4883 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
4886 return memory_address (NARROWEST_INT_MODE, temp);
4889 /* A utility routine that returns the base of an auto-inc memory, or NULL. */
4891 static rtx
4892 mem_autoinc_base (rtx mem)
4894 if (MEM_P (mem))
4896 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
4897 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (addr)) == RTX_AUTOINC)
4898 return XEXP (addr, 0);
4900 return NULL;
4903 /* A utility routine used here, in reload, and in try_split. The insns
4904 after PREV up to and including LAST are known to adjust the stack,
4905 with a final value of END_ARGS_SIZE. Iterate backward from LAST
4906 placing notes as appropriate. PREV may be NULL, indicating the
4907 entire insn sequence prior to LAST should be scanned.
4909 The set of allowed stack pointer modifications is small:
4910 (1) One or more auto-inc style memory references (aka pushes),
4911 (2) One or more addition/subtraction with the SP as destination,
4912 (3) A single move insn with the SP as destination,
4913 (4) A call_pop insn,
4914 (5) Noreturn call insns if !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS.
4916 Insns in the sequence that do not modify the SP are ignored,
4917 except for noreturn calls.
4919 The return value is the amount of adjustment that can be trivially
4920 verified, via immediate operand or auto-inc. If the adjustment
4921 cannot be trivially extracted, the return value is HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN. */
4923 poly_int64
4924 find_args_size_adjust (rtx_insn *insn)
4926 rtx dest, set, pat;
4927 int i;
4929 pat = PATTERN (insn);
4930 set = NULL;
4932 /* Look for a call_pop pattern. */
4933 if (CALL_P (insn))
4935 /* We have to allow non-call_pop patterns for the case
4936 of emit_single_push_insn of a TLS address. */
4937 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
4938 return 0;
4940 /* All call_pop have a stack pointer adjust in the parallel.
4941 The call itself is always first, and the stack adjust is
4942 usually last, so search from the end. */
4943 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i > 0; --i)
4945 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
4946 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
4947 continue;
4948 dest = SET_DEST (set);
4949 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
4950 break;
4952 /* We'd better have found the stack pointer adjust. */
4953 if (i == 0)
4954 return 0;
4955 /* Fall through to process the extracted SET and DEST
4956 as if it was a standalone insn. */
4958 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
4959 set = pat;
4960 else if ((set = single_set (insn)) != NULL)
4962 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
4964 /* ??? Some older ports use a parallel with a stack adjust
4965 and a store for a PUSH_ROUNDING pattern, rather than a
4966 PRE/POST_MODIFY rtx. Don't force them to update yet... */
4967 /* ??? See h8300 and m68k, pushqi1. */
4968 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
4970 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
4971 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
4972 continue;
4973 dest = SET_DEST (set);
4974 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
4975 break;
4977 /* We do not expect an auto-inc of the sp in the parallel. */
4978 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (dest) != stack_pointer_rtx);
4979 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
4980 != stack_pointer_rtx);
4982 if (i < 0)
4983 return 0;
4985 else
4986 return 0;
4988 dest = SET_DEST (set);
4990 /* Look for direct modifications of the stack pointer. */
4991 if (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
4993 /* Look for a trivial adjustment, otherwise assume nothing. */
4994 /* Note that the SPU restore_stack_block pattern refers to
4995 the stack pointer in V4SImode. Consider that non-trivial. */
4996 poly_int64 offset;
4997 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest))
4998 && strip_offset (SET_SRC (set), &offset) == stack_pointer_rtx)
4999 return offset;
5000 /* ??? Reload can generate no-op moves, which will be cleaned
5001 up later. Recognize it and continue searching. */
5002 else if (rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_SRC (set)))
5003 return 0;
5004 else
5005 return HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
5007 else
5009 rtx mem, addr;
5011 /* Otherwise only think about autoinc patterns. */
5012 if (mem_autoinc_base (dest) == stack_pointer_rtx)
5014 mem = dest;
5015 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
5016 != stack_pointer_rtx);
5018 else if (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
5019 mem = SET_SRC (set);
5020 else
5021 return 0;
5023 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
5024 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
5026 case PRE_INC:
5027 case POST_INC:
5028 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
5029 case PRE_DEC:
5030 case POST_DEC:
5031 return -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
5032 case PRE_MODIFY:
5033 case POST_MODIFY:
5034 addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
5035 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS);
5036 gcc_assert (XEXP (addr, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
5037 return rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (addr, 1));
5038 default:
5039 gcc_unreachable ();
5044 poly_int64
5045 fixup_args_size_notes (rtx_insn *prev, rtx_insn *last,
5046 poly_int64 end_args_size)
5048 poly_int64 args_size = end_args_size;
5049 bool saw_unknown = false;
5050 rtx_insn *insn;
5052 for (insn = last; insn != prev; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
5054 if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
5055 continue;
5057 /* We might have existing REG_ARGS_SIZE notes, e.g. when pushing
5058 a call argument containing a TLS address that itself requires
5059 a call to __tls_get_addr. The handling of stack_pointer_delta
5060 in emit_single_push_insn is supposed to ensure that any such
5061 notes are already correct. */
5062 rtx note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, NULL_RTX);
5063 gcc_assert (!note || known_eq (args_size, get_args_size (note)));
5065 poly_int64 this_delta = find_args_size_adjust (insn);
5066 if (known_eq (this_delta, 0))
5068 if (!CALL_P (insn)
5069 || ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
5070 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX) == NULL_RTX)
5071 continue;
5074 gcc_assert (!saw_unknown);
5075 if (known_eq (this_delta, HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN))
5076 saw_unknown = true;
5078 if (!note)
5079 add_args_size_note (insn, args_size);
5080 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
5081 this_delta = -poly_uint64 (this_delta);
5083 if (saw_unknown)
5084 args_size = HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
5085 else
5086 args_size -= this_delta;
5089 return args_size;
5092 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
5093 /* Emit single push insn. */
5095 static void
5096 emit_single_push_insn_1 (machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
5098 rtx dest_addr;
5099 poly_int64 rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
5100 rtx dest;
5101 enum insn_code icode;
5103 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
5104 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
5105 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
5106 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
5108 class expand_operand ops[1];
5110 create_input_operand (&ops[0], x, mode);
5111 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 1, ops))
5112 return;
5114 if (known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), rounded_size))
5115 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
5116 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
5117 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
5118 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
5119 access to type. */
5120 else if (targetm.calls.function_arg_padding (mode, type) == PAD_DOWNWARD)
5122 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
5123 expand_binop (Pmode,
5124 STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD ? sub_optab
5125 : add_optab,
5126 stack_pointer_rtx,
5127 gen_int_mode (rounded_size, Pmode),
5128 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
5130 poly_int64 offset = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
5131 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD && STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
5132 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
5133 previous value. */
5134 offset += rounded_size;
5136 if (!STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD && STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
5137 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
5138 previous value. */
5139 offset -= rounded_size;
5141 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, offset);
5143 else
5145 if (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD)
5146 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
5147 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, -rounded_size);
5148 else
5149 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
5150 dest_addr = plus_constant (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, rounded_size);
5152 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
5155 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
5157 if (type != 0)
5159 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
5161 if (cfun->tail_call_marked)
5162 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
5163 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
5164 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
5165 of sibling calls. */
5166 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
5168 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
5171 /* Emit and annotate a single push insn. */
5173 static void
5174 emit_single_push_insn (machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
5176 poly_int64 delta, old_delta = stack_pointer_delta;
5177 rtx_insn *prev = get_last_insn ();
5178 rtx_insn *last;
5180 emit_single_push_insn_1 (mode, x, type);
5182 /* Adjust stack_pointer_delta to describe the situation after the push
5183 we just performed. Note that we must do this after the push rather
5184 than before the push in case calculating X needs pushes and pops of
5185 its own (e.g. if calling __tls_get_addr). The REG_ARGS_SIZE notes
5186 for such pushes and pops must not include the effect of the future
5187 push of X. */
5188 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
5190 last = get_last_insn ();
5192 /* Notice the common case where we emitted exactly one insn. */
5193 if (PREV_INSN (last) == prev)
5195 add_args_size_note (last, stack_pointer_delta);
5196 return;
5199 delta = fixup_args_size_notes (prev, last, stack_pointer_delta);
5200 gcc_assert (known_eq (delta, HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN)
5201 || known_eq (delta, old_delta));
5203 #endif
5205 /* If reading SIZE bytes from X will end up reading from
5206 Y return the number of bytes that overlap. Return -1
5207 if there is no overlap or -2 if we can't determine
5208 (for example when X and Y have different base registers). */
5210 static int
5211 memory_load_overlap (rtx x, rtx y, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5213 rtx tmp = plus_constant (Pmode, x, size);
5214 rtx sub = simplify_gen_binary (MINUS, Pmode, tmp, y);
5216 if (!CONST_INT_P (sub))
5217 return -2;
5219 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (sub);
5221 return IN_RANGE (val, 1, size) ? val : -1;
5224 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
5225 type TYPE.
5226 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
5227 carry mode info).
5228 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
5229 needed only if X is BLKmode.
5230 Return true if successful. May return false if asked to push a
5231 partial argument during a sibcall optimization (as specified by
5232 SIBCALL_P) and the incoming and outgoing pointers cannot be shown
5233 to not overlap.
5235 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
5237 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
5238 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
5239 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
5240 REG must be a hard register in this case.
5241 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
5242 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
5243 registers.
5245 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
5246 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
5248 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
5249 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
5250 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
5251 argument block has not been preallocated.
5253 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
5255 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
5256 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
5257 of bytes required. */
5259 bool
5260 emit_push_insn (rtx x, machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
5261 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, poly_int64 extra,
5262 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
5263 rtx alignment_pad, bool sibcall_p)
5265 rtx xinner;
5266 pad_direction stack_direction
5267 = STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD ? PAD_DOWNWARD : PAD_UPWARD;
5269 /* Decide where to pad the argument: PAD_DOWNWARD for below,
5270 PAD_UPWARD for above, or PAD_NONE for don't pad it.
5271 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
5272 pad_direction where_pad = targetm.calls.function_arg_padding (mode, type);
5274 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
5275 FIXME: why? */
5276 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
5277 if (where_pad != PAD_NONE)
5278 where_pad = (where_pad == PAD_DOWNWARD ? PAD_UPWARD : PAD_DOWNWARD);
5280 xinner = x;
5282 int nregs = partial / UNITS_PER_WORD;
5283 rtx *tmp_regs = NULL;
5284 int overlapping = 0;
5286 if (mode == BLKmode
5287 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
5289 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
5291 rtx temp;
5292 int used;
5293 int offset;
5294 int skip;
5296 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5297 used = partial - offset;
5299 if (mode != BLKmode)
5301 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
5302 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
5303 necessary. */
5304 size = gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), Pmode);
5305 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
5307 temp = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
5308 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
5309 xinner = temp;
5313 gcc_assert (size);
5315 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
5316 because registers will take care of them. */
5318 if (partial != 0)
5319 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
5321 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
5322 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
5323 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
5324 by setting SKIP to 0. */
5325 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
5327 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
5328 /* NB: Let the backend known the number of bytes to push and
5329 decide if push insns should be generated. */
5330 unsigned int push_size;
5331 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
5332 push_size = INTVAL (size);
5333 else
5334 push_size = 0;
5336 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
5337 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
5338 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
5339 if (args_addr == 0
5340 && targetm.calls.push_argument (push_size)
5341 && CONST_INT_P (size)
5342 && skip == 0
5343 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
5344 && can_move_by_pieces ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align)
5345 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
5346 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
5347 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
5348 && ((!targetm.slow_unaligned_access (word_mode, align))
5349 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
5350 || known_eq (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT),
5351 align / BITS_PER_UNIT))
5352 && known_eq (PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)), INTVAL (size)))
5354 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
5355 or if padding below and stack grows up.
5356 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
5357 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0)
5358 && args_addr == 0
5359 && where_pad != PAD_NONE
5360 && where_pad != stack_direction)
5361 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
5363 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align,
5364 RETURN_BEGIN);
5366 else
5367 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
5369 rtx target;
5371 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
5372 to the address of that space. */
5374 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
5375 if (partial != 0)
5377 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
5378 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
5379 else
5380 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
5381 gen_int_mode (used, GET_MODE (size)),
5382 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5385 /* Get the address of the stack space.
5386 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
5387 A single stack adjust will do. */
5388 poly_int64 const_args_so_far;
5389 if (! args_addr)
5391 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == PAD_DOWNWARD);
5392 extra = 0;
5394 else if (poly_int_rtx_p (args_so_far, &const_args_so_far))
5395 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
5396 plus_constant (Pmode, args_addr,
5397 skip + const_args_so_far));
5398 else
5399 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
5400 plus_constant (Pmode,
5401 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
5402 args_addr,
5403 args_so_far),
5404 skip));
5406 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
5408 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
5409 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
5410 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
5412 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
5413 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
5414 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
5417 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
5419 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
5420 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
5421 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
5422 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
5423 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
5424 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
5425 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
5426 set_mem_align (target, align);
5428 /* If part should go in registers and pushing to that part would
5429 overwrite some of the values that need to go into regs, load the
5430 overlapping values into temporary pseudos to be moved into the hard
5431 regs at the end after the stack pushing has completed.
5432 We cannot load them directly into the hard regs here because
5433 they can be clobbered by the block move expansions.
5434 See PR 65358. */
5436 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0 && mode == BLKmode
5437 && GET_CODE (reg) != PARALLEL)
5439 overlapping = memory_load_overlap (XEXP (x, 0), temp, partial);
5440 if (overlapping > 0)
5442 gcc_assert (overlapping % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
5443 overlapping /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
5445 tmp_regs = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, overlapping);
5447 for (int i = 0; i < overlapping; i++)
5448 tmp_regs[i] = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
5450 for (int i = 0; i < overlapping; i++)
5451 emit_move_insn (tmp_regs[i],
5452 operand_subword_force (target, i, mode));
5454 else if (overlapping == -1)
5455 overlapping = 0;
5456 /* Could not determine whether there is overlap.
5457 Fail the sibcall. */
5458 else
5460 overlapping = 0;
5461 if (sibcall_p)
5462 return false;
5466 /* If source is a constant VAR_DECL with a simple constructor,
5467 store the constructor to the stack instead of moving it. */
5468 const_tree decl;
5469 if (partial == 0
5470 && MEM_P (xinner)
5471 && SYMBOL_REF_P (XEXP (xinner, 0))
5472 && (decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (xinner, 0))) != NULL_TREE
5473 && VAR_P (decl)
5474 && TREE_READONLY (decl)
5475 && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (decl)
5476 && immediate_const_ctor_p (DECL_INITIAL (decl), 2))
5477 store_constructor (DECL_INITIAL (decl), target, 0,
5478 int_expr_size (DECL_INITIAL (decl)), false);
5479 else
5480 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
5483 else if (partial > 0)
5485 /* Scalar partly in registers. This case is only supported
5486 for fixed-wdth modes. */
5487 int num_words = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).to_constant ();
5488 num_words /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
5489 int i;
5490 int not_stack;
5491 /* # bytes of start of argument
5492 that we must make space for but need not store. */
5493 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5494 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
5495 int skip;
5497 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
5498 or if padding below and stack grows up.
5499 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
5500 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0)
5501 && args_addr == 0
5502 && where_pad != PAD_NONE
5503 && where_pad != stack_direction)
5504 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
5506 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
5507 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
5508 and leave the space uninitialized. */
5509 if (args_addr == 0)
5510 offset = 0;
5512 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
5513 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
5514 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
5515 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
5517 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
5518 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
5519 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
5520 by setting SKIP to 0. */
5521 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
5523 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
5524 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
5526 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
5527 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
5528 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
5529 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
5530 x = copy_to_reg (x);
5532 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
5533 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
5534 has a size a multiple of a word. */
5535 for (i = num_words - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
5536 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
5537 if (!emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
5538 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
5539 0, args_addr,
5540 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
5541 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
5542 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad, sibcall_p))
5543 return false;
5545 else
5547 rtx addr;
5548 rtx dest;
5550 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
5551 or if padding below and stack grows up.
5552 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
5553 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0)
5554 && args_addr == 0
5555 && where_pad != PAD_NONE
5556 && where_pad != stack_direction)
5557 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
5559 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
5560 if (args_addr == 0 && targetm.calls.push_argument (0))
5561 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
5562 else
5563 #endif
5565 addr = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, Pmode, args_addr, args_so_far);
5566 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, memory_address (mode, addr));
5568 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
5569 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
5570 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
5571 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
5572 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
5573 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
5574 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
5575 set_mem_align (dest, align);
5577 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
5581 /* Move the partial arguments into the registers and any overlapping
5582 values that we moved into the pseudos in tmp_regs. */
5583 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
5585 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5586 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5587 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
5588 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
5589 else
5591 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
5592 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, nregs - overlapping, mode);
5594 for (int i = 0; i < overlapping; i++)
5595 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, REGNO (reg)
5596 + nregs - overlapping + i),
5597 tmp_regs[i]);
5602 if (maybe_ne (extra, 0) && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
5603 anti_adjust_stack (gen_int_mode (extra, Pmode));
5605 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
5606 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
5608 return true;
5611 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
5612 operations. */
5614 static rtx
5615 get_subtarget (rtx x)
5617 return (optimize
5618 || x == 0
5619 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
5620 || !REG_P (x)
5621 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
5622 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
5623 ? 0 : x);
5626 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
5627 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
5628 and there's nothing else to do. */
5630 static bool
5631 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (poly_uint64 pbitsize,
5632 poly_uint64 pbitpos,
5633 poly_uint64 pbitregion_start,
5634 poly_uint64 pbitregion_end,
5635 machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
5636 tree to, tree src, bool reverse)
5638 /* str_mode is not guaranteed to be a scalar type. */
5639 machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
5640 unsigned int str_bitsize;
5641 tree op0, op1;
5642 rtx value, result;
5643 optab binop;
5644 gimple *srcstmt;
5645 enum tree_code code;
5647 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start, bitregion_end;
5648 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
5649 || !pbitsize.is_constant (&bitsize)
5650 || !pbitpos.is_constant (&bitpos)
5651 || !pbitregion_start.is_constant (&bitregion_start)
5652 || !pbitregion_end.is_constant (&bitregion_end)
5653 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
5654 || !GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode).is_constant (&str_bitsize)
5655 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
5656 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
5657 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
5658 return false;
5660 STRIP_NOPS (src);
5661 if (TREE_CODE (src) != SSA_NAME)
5662 return false;
5663 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
5664 return false;
5666 srcstmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (src);
5667 if (!srcstmt
5668 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt)) != tcc_binary)
5669 return false;
5671 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
5673 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
5675 /* If OP0 is an SSA_NAME, then we want to walk the use-def chain
5676 to find its initialization. Hopefully the initialization will
5677 be from a bitfield load. */
5678 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
5680 gimple *op0stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (op0);
5682 /* We want to eventually have OP0 be the same as TO, which
5683 should be a bitfield. */
5684 if (!op0stmt
5685 || !is_gimple_assign (op0stmt)
5686 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (op0stmt) != TREE_CODE (to))
5687 return false;
5688 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op0stmt);
5691 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt);
5693 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
5694 return false;
5696 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
5698 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
5700 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
5701 str_bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
5703 scalar_int_mode best_mode;
5704 if (!get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
5705 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_bitsize, false, &best_mode))
5706 return false;
5707 str_mode = best_mode;
5708 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (best_mode);
5710 offset1 = bitpos;
5711 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
5712 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
5713 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
5715 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
5716 return false;
5718 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
5719 will likely generate better code. */
5720 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
5721 return false;
5723 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
5724 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
5725 return false;
5727 if (reverse ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5728 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
5730 switch (code)
5732 case PLUS_EXPR:
5733 case MINUS_EXPR:
5734 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
5735 where we don't need to do any masking and also
5736 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
5737 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
5738 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
5739 can be added later. */
5740 if ((reverse || bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
5741 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
5742 break;
5744 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5745 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
5746 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
5747 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
5749 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
5750 we can alias adjacent data. */
5751 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
5753 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
5754 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
5755 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
5758 if (bitsize == 1 && (reverse || bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize))
5760 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
5761 binop = xor_optab;
5763 else
5764 binop = code == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
5766 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
5767 if (reverse)
5768 value = flip_storage_order (str_mode, value);
5769 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
5770 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
5771 if (result != str_rtx)
5772 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
5773 return true;
5775 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
5776 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
5777 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
5778 break;
5779 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5780 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
5781 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
5782 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
5784 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
5785 we can alias adjacent data. */
5786 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
5788 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
5789 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
5790 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
5793 binop = code == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
5794 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
5796 rtx mask = gen_int_mode ((HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << bitsize) - 1,
5797 str_mode);
5798 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, mask, NULL_RTX);
5800 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value, bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
5801 if (reverse)
5802 value = flip_storage_order (str_mode, value);
5803 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
5804 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
5805 if (result != str_rtx)
5806 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
5807 return true;
5809 default:
5810 break;
5813 return false;
5816 /* In the C++ memory model, consecutive bit fields in a structure are
5817 considered one memory location.
5819 Given a COMPONENT_REF EXP at position (BITPOS, OFFSET), this function
5820 returns the bit range of consecutive bits in which this COMPONENT_REF
5821 belongs. The values are returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND. *BITPOS
5822 and *OFFSET may be adjusted in the process.
5824 If the access does not need to be restricted, 0 is returned in both
5825 *BITSTART and *BITEND. */
5827 void
5828 get_bit_range (poly_uint64 *bitstart, poly_uint64 *bitend, tree exp,
5829 poly_int64 *bitpos, tree *offset)
5831 poly_int64 bitoffset;
5832 tree field, repr;
5834 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF);
5836 field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
5837 repr = DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE (field);
5838 /* If we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE there is no
5839 need to limit the range we can access. */
5840 if (!repr)
5842 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
5843 return;
5846 /* If we have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_REPRESENTATIVE but the enclosing record is
5847 part of a larger bit field, then the representative does not serve any
5848 useful purpose. This can occur in Ada. */
5849 if (handled_component_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
5851 machine_mode rmode;
5852 poly_int64 rbitsize, rbitpos;
5853 tree roffset;
5854 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
5855 get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), &rbitsize, &rbitpos,
5856 &roffset, &rmode, &unsignedp, &reversep,
5857 &volatilep);
5858 if (!multiple_p (rbitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT))
5860 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
5861 return;
5865 /* Compute the adjustment to bitpos from the offset of the field
5866 relative to the representative. DECL_FIELD_OFFSET of field and
5867 repr are the same by construction if they are not constants,
5868 see finish_bitfield_layout. */
5869 poly_uint64 field_offset, repr_offset;
5870 if (poly_int_tree_p (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), &field_offset)
5871 && poly_int_tree_p (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (repr), &repr_offset))
5872 bitoffset = (field_offset - repr_offset) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
5873 else
5874 bitoffset = 0;
5875 bitoffset += (tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field))
5876 - tree_to_uhwi (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (repr)));
5878 /* If the adjustment is larger than bitpos, we would have a negative bit
5879 position for the lower bound and this may wreak havoc later. Adjust
5880 offset and bitpos to make the lower bound non-negative in that case. */
5881 if (maybe_gt (bitoffset, *bitpos))
5883 poly_int64 adjust_bits = upper_bound (bitoffset, *bitpos) - *bitpos;
5884 poly_int64 adjust_bytes = exact_div (adjust_bits, BITS_PER_UNIT);
5886 *bitpos += adjust_bits;
5887 if (*offset == NULL_TREE)
5888 *offset = size_int (-adjust_bytes);
5889 else
5890 *offset = size_binop (MINUS_EXPR, *offset, size_int (adjust_bytes));
5891 *bitstart = 0;
5893 else
5894 *bitstart = *bitpos - bitoffset;
5896 *bitend = *bitstart + tree_to_poly_uint64 (DECL_SIZE (repr)) - 1;
5899 /* Returns true if BASE is a DECL that does not reside in memory and
5900 has non-BLKmode. DECL_RTL must not be a MEM; if
5901 DECL_RTL was not set yet, return false. */
5903 bool
5904 non_mem_decl_p (tree base)
5906 if (!DECL_P (base)
5907 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
5908 || DECL_MODE (base) == BLKmode)
5909 return false;
5911 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (base))
5912 return false;
5914 return (!MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)));
5917 /* Returns true if REF refers to an object that does not
5918 reside in memory and has non-BLKmode. */
5920 bool
5921 mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (tree ref)
5923 tree base;
5925 if (TREE_CODE (ref) == MEM_REF
5926 || TREE_CODE (ref) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
5928 tree addr = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
5930 if (TREE_CODE (addr) != ADDR_EXPR)
5931 return false;
5933 base = TREE_OPERAND (addr, 0);
5935 else
5936 base = ref;
5938 return non_mem_decl_p (base);
5941 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
5942 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
5944 void
5945 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
5947 rtx to_rtx = 0;
5948 rtx result;
5949 machine_mode mode;
5950 unsigned int align;
5951 enum insn_code icode;
5953 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
5954 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
5956 expand_normal (from);
5957 return;
5960 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
5961 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
5962 return;
5964 /* Handle misaligned stores. */
5965 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
5966 if ((TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
5967 || TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF
5968 || DECL_P (to))
5969 && mode != BLKmode
5970 && !mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)
5971 && ((align = get_object_alignment (to))
5972 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
5973 && (((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
5974 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
5975 || targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, align)))
5977 rtx reg, mem;
5979 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5980 /* Handle PARALLEL. */
5981 reg = maybe_emit_group_store (reg, TREE_TYPE (from));
5982 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
5983 mem = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
5984 if (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF && REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (to))
5985 reg = flip_storage_order (mode, reg);
5987 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
5989 class expand_operand ops[2];
5991 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
5992 create_input_operand (&ops[1], reg, mode);
5993 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
5994 would silently be omitted. */
5995 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
5997 else
5998 store_bit_field (mem, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0, 0, 0, mode, reg,
5999 false, false);
6000 return;
6003 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
6004 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
6005 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
6006 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
6007 problem. Same for (partially) storing into a non-memory object. */
6008 if (handled_component_p (to)
6009 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
6010 && (REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (to)
6011 || mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)))
6012 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
6014 machine_mode mode1;
6015 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
6016 poly_uint64 bitregion_start = 0;
6017 poly_uint64 bitregion_end = 0;
6018 tree offset;
6019 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
6020 tree tem;
6022 push_temp_slots ();
6023 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
6024 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
6026 /* Make sure bitpos is not negative, it can wreak havoc later. */
6027 if (maybe_lt (bitpos, 0))
6029 gcc_assert (offset == NULL_TREE);
6030 offset = size_int (bits_to_bytes_round_down (bitpos));
6031 bitpos = num_trailing_bits (bitpos);
6034 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
6035 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
6036 get_bit_range (&bitregion_start, &bitregion_end, to, &bitpos, &offset);
6037 /* The C++ memory model naturally applies to byte-aligned fields.
6038 However, if we do not have a DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE but BITPOS or
6039 BITSIZE are not byte-aligned, there is no need to limit the range
6040 we can access. This can occur with packed structures in Ada. */
6041 else if (maybe_gt (bitsize, 0)
6042 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT)
6043 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT))
6045 bitregion_start = bitpos;
6046 bitregion_end = bitpos + bitsize - 1;
6049 to_rtx = expand_expr (tem, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
6051 /* If the field has a mode, we want to access it in the
6052 field's mode, not the computed mode.
6053 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
6054 use BLKmode for it instead. */
6055 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
6057 if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
6058 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
6059 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == VOIDmode)
6060 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, BLKmode, 0);
6063 if (offset != 0)
6065 machine_mode address_mode;
6066 rtx offset_rtx;
6068 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
6070 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
6071 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
6072 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
6073 expand_builtin_trap ();
6074 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
6077 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
6078 address_mode = get_address_mode (to_rtx);
6079 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
6081 /* We cannot be sure that the RTL in offset_rtx is valid outside
6082 of a memory address context, so force it into a register
6083 before attempting to convert it to the desired mode. */
6084 offset_rtx = force_operand (offset_rtx, NULL_RTX);
6085 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
6088 /* If we have an expression in OFFSET_RTX and a non-zero
6089 byte offset in BITPOS, adding the byte offset before the
6090 OFFSET_RTX results in better intermediate code, which makes
6091 later rtl optimization passes perform better.
6093 We prefer intermediate code like this:
6095 r124:DI=r123:DI+0x18
6096 [r124:DI]=r121:DI
6098 ... instead of ...
6100 r124:DI=r123:DI+0x10
6101 [r124:DI+0x8]=r121:DI
6103 This is only done for aligned data values, as these can
6104 be expected to result in single move instructions. */
6105 poly_int64 bytepos;
6106 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
6107 && maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)
6108 && maybe_gt (bitsize, 0)
6109 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
6110 && multiple_p (bitpos, bitsize)
6111 && multiple_p (bitsize, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
6112 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
6114 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bytepos);
6115 bitregion_start = 0;
6116 if (known_ge (bitregion_end, poly_uint64 (bitpos)))
6117 bitregion_end -= bitpos;
6118 bitpos = 0;
6121 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
6122 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
6123 offset));
6126 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
6127 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
6128 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
6129 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
6130 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
6131 && known_ge (bitpos, GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (to_rtx))))
6133 expand_normal (from);
6134 result = NULL;
6136 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
6137 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
6139 machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to_rtx);
6140 gcc_checking_assert (COMPLEX_MODE_P (to_mode));
6141 poly_int64 mode_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode);
6142 unsigned short inner_bitsize = GET_MODE_UNIT_BITSIZE (to_mode);
6143 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == to_mode
6144 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
6145 && known_eq (bitsize, mode_bitsize))
6146 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal, reversep);
6147 else if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == GET_MODE_INNER (to_mode)
6148 && known_eq (bitsize, inner_bitsize)
6149 && (known_eq (bitpos, 0)
6150 || known_eq (bitpos, inner_bitsize)))
6151 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)),
6152 false, nontemporal, reversep);
6153 else if (known_le (bitpos + bitsize, inner_bitsize))
6154 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), bitsize, bitpos,
6155 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6156 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
6157 nontemporal, reversep);
6158 else if (known_ge (bitpos, inner_bitsize))
6159 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), bitsize,
6160 bitpos - inner_bitsize,
6161 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6162 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
6163 nontemporal, reversep);
6164 else if (known_eq (bitpos, 0) && known_eq (bitsize, mode_bitsize))
6166 result = expand_normal (from);
6167 if (GET_CODE (result) == CONCAT)
6169 to_mode = GET_MODE_INNER (to_mode);
6170 machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (result));
6171 rtx from_real
6172 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, XEXP (result, 0),
6173 from_mode, 0);
6174 rtx from_imag
6175 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, XEXP (result, 1),
6176 from_mode, 0);
6177 if (!from_real || !from_imag)
6178 goto concat_store_slow;
6179 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), from_real);
6180 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), from_imag);
6182 else
6184 machine_mode from_mode
6185 = GET_MODE (result) == VOIDmode
6186 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from))
6187 : GET_MODE (result);
6188 rtx from_rtx;
6189 if (MEM_P (result))
6190 from_rtx = change_address (result, to_mode, NULL_RTX);
6191 else
6192 from_rtx
6193 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, result, from_mode, 0);
6194 if (from_rtx)
6196 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
6197 read_complex_part (from_rtx, false));
6198 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1),
6199 read_complex_part (from_rtx, true));
6201 else
6203 to_mode = GET_MODE_INNER (to_mode);
6204 rtx from_real
6205 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, result, from_mode, 0);
6206 rtx from_imag
6207 = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, result, from_mode,
6208 GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode));
6209 if (!from_real || !from_imag)
6210 goto concat_store_slow;
6211 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), from_real);
6212 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), from_imag);
6216 else
6218 concat_store_slow:;
6219 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
6220 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
6221 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), false, true);
6222 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 1), true, false);
6223 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos,
6224 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6225 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
6226 nontemporal, reversep);
6227 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), read_complex_part (temp, false));
6228 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), read_complex_part (temp, true));
6231 /* For calls to functions returning variable length structures, if TO_RTX
6232 is not a MEM, go through a MEM because we must not create temporaries
6233 of the VLA type. */
6234 else if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
6235 && TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR
6236 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
6237 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) != INTEGER_CST)
6239 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
6240 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)));
6241 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start,
6242 bitregion_end, mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
6243 nontemporal, reversep);
6244 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
6246 else
6248 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
6250 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
6251 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
6252 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6253 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
6254 if (volatilep)
6255 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
6258 gcc_checking_assert (known_ge (bitpos, 0));
6259 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos,
6260 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6261 mode1, to_rtx, to, from,
6262 reversep))
6263 result = NULL;
6264 else if (SUBREG_P (to_rtx)
6265 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to_rtx))
6267 /* If to_rtx is a promoted subreg, we need to zero or sign
6268 extend the value afterwards. */
6269 if (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
6270 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) != BLKmode
6271 && !REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (to)
6272 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
6273 && known_eq (bitsize, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx))))
6274 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal, false);
6275 else
6277 rtx to_rtx1
6278 = lowpart_subreg (subreg_unpromoted_mode (to_rtx),
6279 SUBREG_REG (to_rtx),
6280 subreg_promoted_mode (to_rtx));
6281 result = store_field (to_rtx1, bitsize, bitpos,
6282 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6283 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
6284 nontemporal, reversep);
6285 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (to_rtx), to_rtx1,
6286 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (to_rtx));
6289 else
6290 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
6291 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6292 mode1, from, get_alias_set (to),
6293 nontemporal, reversep);
6296 if (result)
6297 preserve_temp_slots (result);
6298 pop_temp_slots ();
6299 return;
6302 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
6303 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
6304 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
6305 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
6306 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
6308 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
6309 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
6310 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
6311 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
6312 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
6313 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
6314 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
6315 && ! (((VAR_P (to)
6316 || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL
6317 || TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL)
6318 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
6319 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
6321 rtx value;
6323 push_temp_slots ();
6324 value = expand_normal (from);
6326 if (to_rtx == 0)
6327 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
6329 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
6330 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6331 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
6333 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
6334 emit_group_move (to_rtx, value);
6335 else
6336 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
6337 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
6339 else if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
6340 emit_group_store (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
6341 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
6342 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
6344 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
6345 if (REG_P (value))
6346 copy_blkmode_from_reg (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from));
6347 else
6348 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6350 else
6352 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
6353 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
6354 (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (to_rtx)), value,
6355 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
6357 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
6360 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
6361 pop_temp_slots ();
6362 return;
6365 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx. */
6366 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
6368 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
6369 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
6370 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
6372 rtx temp;
6374 push_temp_slots ();
6376 /* If the source is itself a return value, it still is in a pseudo at
6377 this point so we can move it back to the return register directly. */
6378 if (REG_P (to_rtx)
6379 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == BLKmode
6380 && TREE_CODE (from) != CALL_EXPR)
6381 temp = copy_blkmode_to_reg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), from);
6382 else
6383 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
6385 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
6386 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6387 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
6389 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
6390 emit_group_move (to_rtx, temp);
6391 else
6392 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
6393 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
6395 else if (temp)
6396 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
6398 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
6399 pop_temp_slots ();
6400 return;
6403 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
6404 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
6405 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
6406 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
6407 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
6408 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
6409 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
6410 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
6411 && cfun->returns_struct
6412 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
6414 rtx from_rtx, size;
6416 push_temp_slots ();
6417 size = expr_size (from);
6418 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
6420 emit_block_move_via_libcall (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), XEXP (from_rtx, 0), size);
6422 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
6423 pop_temp_slots ();
6424 return;
6427 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
6429 push_temp_slots ();
6430 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal, false);
6431 preserve_temp_slots (result);
6432 pop_temp_slots ();
6433 return;
6436 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
6437 succeeded, false otherwise. */
6439 bool
6440 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
6442 class expand_operand ops[2];
6443 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to);
6444 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
6446 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
6447 return false;
6449 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], to);
6450 create_input_operand (&ops[1], from, mode);
6451 return maybe_expand_insn (code, 2, ops);
6454 /* Helper function for store_expr storing of STRING_CST. */
6456 static rtx
6457 string_cst_read_str (void *data, void *, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
6458 fixed_size_mode mode)
6460 tree str = (tree) data;
6462 gcc_assert (offset >= 0);
6463 if (offset >= TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str))
6464 return const0_rtx;
6466 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) offset + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
6467 > (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str))
6469 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
6470 size_t l = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - offset;
6471 memcpy (p, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str) + offset, l);
6472 memset (p + l, '\0', GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - l);
6473 return c_readstr (p, mode, false);
6476 return c_readstr (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str) + offset, mode, false);
6479 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
6480 and storing the value into TARGET.
6482 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
6483 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
6484 because C has no operators that could combine two different
6485 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
6486 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
6487 be more thorough?
6489 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
6490 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
6492 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction.
6494 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order. */
6497 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p,
6498 bool nontemporal, bool reverse)
6500 rtx temp;
6501 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
6502 location_t loc = curr_insn_location ();
6503 bool shortened_string_cst = false;
6505 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6507 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
6508 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
6509 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
6510 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
6511 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6512 return NULL_RTX;
6514 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
6516 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
6517 part. */
6518 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
6519 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
6520 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
6521 call_param_p, nontemporal, reverse);
6523 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
6525 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
6526 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
6527 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
6528 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
6530 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), *lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
6532 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
6533 NO_DEFER_POP;
6534 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1,
6535 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
6536 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
6537 nontemporal, reverse);
6538 emit_jump_insn (targetm.gen_jump (lab2));
6539 emit_barrier ();
6540 emit_label (lab1);
6541 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
6542 nontemporal, reverse);
6543 emit_label (lab2);
6544 OK_DEFER_POP;
6546 return NULL_RTX;
6548 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
6549 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
6550 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
6551 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
6552 expression. */
6554 rtx inner_target = 0;
6555 scalar_int_mode outer_mode = subreg_unpromoted_mode (target);
6556 scalar_int_mode inner_mode = subreg_promoted_mode (target);
6558 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
6559 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
6560 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
6561 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
6562 since then the conversion might involve more than just
6563 converting modes. */
6564 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6565 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
6566 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (outer_mode)
6567 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6569 if (!SUBREG_CHECK_PROMOTED_SIGN (target,
6570 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
6572 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
6573 version, so use the mode instead. */
6574 tree ntype
6575 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
6576 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6577 if (ntype == NULL)
6578 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
6579 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
6580 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
6582 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
6585 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
6586 (inner_mode, SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target)),
6587 exp);
6589 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
6592 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
6593 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
6596 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
6597 sure that we properly convert it. */
6598 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
6600 temp = convert_modes (outer_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
6601 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
6602 temp = convert_modes (inner_mode, outer_mode, temp,
6603 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
6605 else if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (temp)))
6606 temp = convert_modes (outer_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
6607 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
6609 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
6610 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGN (target));
6612 return NULL_RTX;
6614 else if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
6615 || (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
6616 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6617 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6618 == STRING_CST
6619 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
6620 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
6621 && MEM_P (target))
6623 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
6624 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
6625 rtx dest_mem;
6626 tree str = TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
6627 ? exp : TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6629 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
6630 if (exp_len <= 0)
6631 goto normal_expr;
6633 if (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) <= 0)
6634 goto normal_expr;
6636 if (can_store_by_pieces (exp_len, string_cst_read_str, (void *) str,
6637 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
6639 store_by_pieces (target, exp_len, string_cst_read_str, (void *) str,
6640 MEM_ALIGN (target), false, RETURN_BEGIN);
6641 return NULL_RTX;
6644 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
6646 /* Trailing NUL bytes in EXP will be handled by the call to
6647 clear_storage, which is more efficient than copying them from
6648 the STRING_CST, so trim those from STR_COPY_LEN. */
6649 while (str_copy_len)
6651 if (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)[str_copy_len - 1])
6652 break;
6653 str_copy_len--;
6656 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0)
6658 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
6659 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
6661 if (str_copy_len >= exp_len)
6662 goto normal_expr;
6664 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, string_cst_read_str,
6665 (void *) str, MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
6666 goto normal_expr;
6668 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (target, str_copy_len, string_cst_read_str,
6669 (void *) str, MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
6670 RETURN_END);
6671 clear_storage (adjust_address_1 (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0, 1, 1, 0,
6672 exp_len - str_copy_len),
6673 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6674 return NULL_RTX;
6676 else
6678 rtx tmp_target;
6680 normal_expr:
6681 /* If we want to use a nontemporal or a reverse order store, force the
6682 value into a register first. */
6683 tmp_target = nontemporal || reverse ? NULL_RTX : target;
6684 tree rexp = exp;
6685 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
6686 && tmp_target == target
6687 && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
6688 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == BLKmode)
6690 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
6691 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
6692 && size != const0_rtx
6693 && (UINTVAL (size)
6694 > ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp) + 32)))
6696 /* If the STRING_CST has much larger array type than
6697 TREE_STRING_LENGTH, only emit the TREE_STRING_LENGTH part of
6698 it into the rodata section as the code later on will use
6699 memset zero for the remainder anyway. See PR95052. */
6700 tmp_target = NULL_RTX;
6701 rexp = copy_node (exp);
6702 tree index
6703 = build_index_type (size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp) - 1));
6704 TREE_TYPE (rexp) = build_array_type (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
6705 index);
6706 shortened_string_cst = true;
6709 temp = expand_expr_real (rexp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
6710 (call_param_p
6711 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
6712 &alt_rtl, false);
6713 if (shortened_string_cst)
6715 gcc_assert (MEM_P (temp));
6716 temp = change_address (temp, BLKmode, NULL_RTX);
6720 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
6721 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
6722 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE or CONST_WIDE_INT and we want
6723 only a word-sized value. */
6724 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
6725 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
6726 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6728 gcc_assert (!shortened_string_cst);
6729 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target))
6730 != GET_MODE_CLASS (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6731 && known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)),
6732 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
6734 rtx t = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (target), temp,
6735 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 0);
6736 if (t)
6737 temp = t;
6739 if (GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
6740 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
6741 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6744 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
6745 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
6746 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
6747 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
6748 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
6750 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
6751 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
6752 two cases:
6753 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
6754 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
6755 to == .
6756 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
6757 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
6758 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
6759 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
6760 of volatile memory references. */
6762 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
6763 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
6764 || side_effects_p (target)
6765 || (MEM_P (temp)
6766 && !mems_same_for_tbaa_p (temp, target)))))
6767 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
6768 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
6769 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
6770 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
6771 && !(alt_rtl
6772 && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target)
6773 && !side_effects_p (alt_rtl)
6774 && !side_effects_p (target))
6775 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
6776 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
6777 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
6778 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
6779 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
6781 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target) && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
6783 gcc_assert (!shortened_string_cst);
6784 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
6786 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
6787 if (REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
6788 copy_blkmode_from_reg (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
6789 else
6790 store_bit_field (target,
6791 rtx_to_poly_int64 (expr_size (exp))
6792 * BITS_PER_UNIT,
6793 0, 0, 0, GET_MODE (temp), temp, reverse,
6794 false);
6796 else
6797 convert_move (target, temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6800 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
6802 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
6803 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
6804 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
6805 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
6806 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
6808 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
6809 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
6810 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
6811 (call_param_p
6812 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
6813 else
6815 machine_mode pointer_mode
6816 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
6817 machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (target);
6819 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
6820 tree copy_size
6821 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
6822 make_tree (sizetype, size),
6823 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
6824 rtx copy_size_rtx
6825 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
6826 (call_param_p
6827 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
6828 rtx_code_label *label = 0;
6830 /* Copy that much. */
6831 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
6832 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
6833 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
6834 (call_param_p
6835 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
6837 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
6838 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
6839 poly_int64 const_copy_size;
6840 if (poly_int_rtx_p (copy_size_rtx, &const_copy_size))
6842 size = plus_constant (address_mode, size, -const_copy_size);
6843 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode, const_copy_size);
6845 else
6847 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
6848 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
6849 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
6851 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
6852 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
6853 copy_size_rtx,
6854 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
6856 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
6857 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
6858 label = gen_label_rtx ();
6859 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
6860 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
6863 if (size != const0_rtx)
6864 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6866 if (label)
6867 emit_label (label);
6870 else if (shortened_string_cst)
6871 gcc_unreachable ();
6872 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
6873 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
6874 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
6876 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
6877 emit_group_move (target, temp);
6878 else
6879 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
6880 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6882 else if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
6883 emit_group_store (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
6884 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6885 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
6886 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
6887 (call_param_p
6888 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
6889 /* If we emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to do. */
6890 else if (nontemporal && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
6892 else
6894 if (reverse)
6895 temp = flip_storage_order (GET_MODE (target), temp);
6896 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
6897 if (temp != target)
6898 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
6901 else
6902 gcc_assert (!shortened_string_cst);
6904 return NULL_RTX;
6907 /* Return true if field F of structure TYPE is a flexible array. */
6909 static bool
6910 flexible_array_member_p (const_tree f, const_tree type)
6912 const_tree tf;
6914 tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
6915 return (DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
6916 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
6917 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
6918 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
6919 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
6920 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
6921 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0);
6924 /* If FOR_CTOR_P, return the number of top-level elements that a constructor
6925 must have in order for it to completely initialize a value of type TYPE.
6926 Return -1 if the number isn't known.
6928 If !FOR_CTOR_P, return an estimate of the number of scalars in TYPE. */
6930 static HOST_WIDE_INT
6931 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool for_ctor_p)
6933 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
6935 case ARRAY_TYPE:
6937 tree nelts;
6939 nelts = array_type_nelts (type);
6940 if (nelts && tree_fits_uhwi_p (nelts))
6942 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
6944 n = tree_to_uhwi (nelts) + 1;
6945 if (n == 0 || for_ctor_p)
6946 return n;
6947 else
6948 return n * count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
6950 return for_ctor_p ? -1 : 1;
6953 case RECORD_TYPE:
6955 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
6956 tree f;
6958 n = 0;
6959 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
6960 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
6962 if (!for_ctor_p)
6963 n += count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
6964 else if (!flexible_array_member_p (f, type))
6965 /* Don't count flexible arrays, which are not supposed
6966 to be initialized. */
6967 n += 1;
6970 return n;
6973 case UNION_TYPE:
6974 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
6976 tree f;
6977 HOST_WIDE_INT n, m;
6979 gcc_assert (!for_ctor_p);
6980 /* Estimate the number of scalars in each field and pick the
6981 maximum. Other estimates would do instead; the idea is simply
6982 to make sure that the estimate is not sensitive to the ordering
6983 of the fields. */
6984 n = 1;
6985 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
6986 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
6988 m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
6989 /* If the field doesn't span the whole union, add an extra
6990 scalar for the rest. */
6991 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (f)),
6992 TYPE_SIZE (type)) != 1)
6993 m++;
6994 if (n < m)
6995 n = m;
6997 return n;
7000 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
7001 return 2;
7003 case VECTOR_TYPE:
7005 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nelts;
7006 if (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type).is_constant (&nelts))
7007 return nelts;
7008 else
7009 return -1;
7012 case INTEGER_TYPE:
7013 case REAL_TYPE:
7014 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
7015 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
7016 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
7017 case POINTER_TYPE:
7018 case OFFSET_TYPE:
7019 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
7020 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
7021 case OPAQUE_TYPE:
7022 case BITINT_TYPE:
7023 return 1;
7025 case ERROR_MARK:
7026 return 0;
7028 case VOID_TYPE:
7029 case METHOD_TYPE:
7030 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
7031 case LANG_TYPE:
7032 default:
7033 gcc_unreachable ();
7037 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
7039 static bool
7040 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
7041 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_unique_nz_elts,
7042 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
7044 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7045 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, unique_nz_elts, init_elts, num_fields;
7046 tree value, purpose, elt_type;
7048 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
7049 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
7050 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
7051 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
7052 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
7054 nz_elts = 0;
7055 unique_nz_elts = 0;
7056 init_elts = 0;
7057 num_fields = 0;
7058 elt_type = NULL_TREE;
7060 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
7062 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
7064 if (purpose && TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
7066 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
7067 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
7069 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (lo_index) && tree_fits_uhwi_p (hi_index))
7070 mult = (tree_to_uhwi (hi_index)
7071 - tree_to_uhwi (lo_index) + 1);
7073 num_fields += mult;
7074 elt_type = TREE_TYPE (value);
7076 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
7078 case CONSTRUCTOR:
7080 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, unz = 0, ic = 0;
7082 bool const_elt_p = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &unz,
7083 &ic, p_complete);
7085 nz_elts += mult * nz;
7086 unique_nz_elts += unz;
7087 init_elts += mult * ic;
7089 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
7090 const_p = const_elt_p;
7092 break;
7094 case INTEGER_CST:
7095 case REAL_CST:
7096 case FIXED_CST:
7097 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
7099 nz_elts += mult;
7100 unique_nz_elts++;
7102 init_elts += mult;
7103 break;
7105 case STRING_CST:
7106 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
7107 unique_nz_elts += TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
7108 init_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
7109 break;
7111 case COMPLEX_CST:
7112 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
7114 nz_elts += mult;
7115 unique_nz_elts++;
7117 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
7119 nz_elts += mult;
7120 unique_nz_elts++;
7122 init_elts += 2 * mult;
7123 break;
7125 case VECTOR_CST:
7127 /* We can only construct constant-length vectors using
7128 CONSTRUCTOR. */
7129 unsigned int nunits = VECTOR_CST_NELTS (value).to_constant ();
7130 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < nunits; ++i)
7132 tree v = VECTOR_CST_ELT (value, i);
7133 if (!initializer_zerop (v))
7135 nz_elts += mult;
7136 unique_nz_elts++;
7138 init_elts += mult;
7141 break;
7143 default:
7145 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (elt_type, false);
7146 nz_elts += mult * tc;
7147 unique_nz_elts += tc;
7148 init_elts += mult * tc;
7150 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
7151 const_p
7152 = initializer_constant_valid_p (value,
7153 elt_type,
7154 TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER
7155 (TREE_TYPE (ctor)))
7156 != NULL_TREE;
7158 break;
7162 if (*p_complete && !complete_ctor_at_level_p (TREE_TYPE (ctor),
7163 num_fields, elt_type))
7164 *p_complete = false;
7166 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
7167 *p_unique_nz_elts += unique_nz_elts;
7168 *p_init_elts += init_elts;
7170 return const_p;
7173 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
7174 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
7175 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
7176 * the same, but counting RANGE_EXPRs as multiplier of 1 instead of
7177 high - low + 1 (this can be useful for callers to determine ctors
7178 that could be cheaply initialized with - perhaps nested - loops
7179 compared to copied from huge read-only data),
7180 and place it in *P_UNIQUE_NZ_ELTS;
7181 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
7182 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
7183 * whether the constructor is complete -- in the sense that every
7184 meaningful byte is explicitly given a value --
7185 and place it in *P_COMPLETE.
7187 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
7188 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
7190 bool
7191 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
7192 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_unique_nz_elts,
7193 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
7195 *p_nz_elts = 0;
7196 *p_unique_nz_elts = 0;
7197 *p_init_elts = 0;
7198 *p_complete = true;
7200 return categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_unique_nz_elts,
7201 p_init_elts, p_complete);
7204 /* Return true if constructor CTOR is simple enough to be materialized
7205 in an integer mode register. Limit the size to WORDS words, which
7206 is 1 by default. */
7208 bool
7209 immediate_const_ctor_p (const_tree ctor, unsigned int words)
7211 /* Allow function to be called with a VAR_DECL's DECL_INITIAL. */
7212 if (!ctor || TREE_CODE (ctor) != CONSTRUCTOR)
7213 return false;
7215 return TREE_CONSTANT (ctor)
7216 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (ctor)
7217 && CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (ctor)
7218 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)) != ARRAY_TYPE
7219 && int_expr_size (ctor) <= words * UNITS_PER_WORD
7220 && initializer_constant_valid_for_bitfield_p (ctor);
7223 /* TYPE is initialized by a constructor with NUM_ELTS elements, the last
7224 of which had type LAST_TYPE. Each element was itself a complete
7225 initializer, in the sense that every meaningful byte was explicitly
7226 given a value. Return true if the same is true for the constructor
7227 as a whole. */
7229 bool
7230 complete_ctor_at_level_p (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT num_elts,
7231 const_tree last_type)
7233 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
7234 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
7236 if (num_elts == 0)
7237 return false;
7239 gcc_assert (num_elts == 1 && last_type);
7241 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
7242 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
7243 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
7244 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
7245 return simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (type), TYPE_SIZE (last_type)) == 1;
7248 return count_type_elements (type, true) == num_elts;
7251 /* Return true if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
7253 static bool
7254 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
7256 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7258 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, unz_elts, init_elts;
7259 bool complete_p;
7261 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &unz_elts, &init_elts,
7262 &complete_p);
7263 return !complete_p || nz_elts < init_elts / 4;
7266 return initializer_zerop (exp);
7269 /* Return true if EXP contains all zeros. */
7271 static bool
7272 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
7274 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7276 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, unz_elts, init_elts;
7277 bool complete_p;
7279 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &unz_elts, &init_elts,
7280 &complete_p);
7281 return nz_elts == 0;
7284 return initializer_zerop (exp);
7287 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
7288 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
7289 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
7290 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
7291 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order.
7293 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
7294 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
7295 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
7296 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
7298 static void
7299 store_constructor_field (rtx target, poly_uint64 bitsize, poly_int64 bitpos,
7300 poly_uint64 bitregion_start,
7301 poly_uint64 bitregion_end,
7302 machine_mode mode,
7303 tree exp, int cleared,
7304 alias_set_type alias_set, bool reverse)
7306 poly_int64 bytepos;
7307 poly_uint64 bytesize;
7308 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
7309 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
7310 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
7311 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
7312 && maybe_ne (bitsize, 0U)
7313 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytesize)
7314 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
7315 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
7316 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
7317 && (known_eq (bitpos, 0) || MEM_P (target)))
7319 if (MEM_P (target))
7321 machine_mode target_mode = GET_MODE (target);
7322 if (target_mode != BLKmode
7323 && !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (target_mode)))
7324 target_mode = BLKmode;
7325 target = adjust_address (target, target_mode, bytepos);
7329 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
7330 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
7331 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
7333 target = copy_rtx (target);
7334 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
7337 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bytesize, reverse);
7339 else
7340 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, bitregion_start, bitregion_end, mode,
7341 exp, alias_set, false, reverse);
7345 /* Returns the number of FIELD_DECLs in TYPE. */
7347 static int
7348 fields_length (const_tree type)
7350 tree t = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
7351 int count = 0;
7353 for (; t; t = DECL_CHAIN (t))
7354 if (TREE_CODE (t) == FIELD_DECL)
7355 ++count;
7357 return count;
7361 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
7362 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
7363 safe_from_p has been called.
7364 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
7365 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
7366 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
7367 which has been packed to exclude padding bits.
7368 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order. */
7370 void
7371 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, poly_int64 size,
7372 bool reverse)
7374 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7375 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
7376 poly_int64 bitregion_end = known_gt (size, 0) ? size * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1 : 0;
7378 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
7380 case RECORD_TYPE:
7381 case UNION_TYPE:
7382 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
7384 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7385 tree field, value;
7387 /* The storage order is specified for every aggregate type. */
7388 reverse = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type);
7390 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
7391 if (known_eq (size, 0) || cleared)
7392 cleared = 1;
7393 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
7394 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
7395 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
7396 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
7397 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
7399 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7400 cleared = 1;
7403 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
7404 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
7405 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
7406 this probably loses. */
7407 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
7408 && known_le (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)),
7409 REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))))
7411 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
7412 cleared = 1;
7415 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
7416 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
7417 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
7418 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
7419 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
7420 else if (known_size_p (size)
7421 && (((int) CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp) != fields_length (type))
7422 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
7423 && (!REG_P (target)
7424 || known_eq (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)), size)))
7426 clear_storage (target, gen_int_mode (size, Pmode),
7427 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7428 cleared = 1;
7431 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
7432 emit_clobber (target);
7434 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
7435 corresponding field of TARGET. */
7436 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
7438 machine_mode mode;
7439 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
7440 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
7441 tree offset;
7442 rtx to_rtx = target;
7444 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
7445 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
7446 if (field == 0)
7447 continue;
7449 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
7450 continue;
7452 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE (field)))
7453 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (DECL_SIZE (field));
7454 else
7455 gcc_unreachable ();
7457 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
7458 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
7459 mode = VOIDmode;
7461 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
7462 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (offset)
7463 && tree_fits_shwi_p (bit_position (field)))
7465 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
7466 offset = NULL_TREE;
7468 else
7469 gcc_unreachable ();
7471 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
7472 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
7473 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
7474 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
7475 can understand. */
7476 if (WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
7477 && REG_P (target)
7478 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
7479 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
7480 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
7481 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
7482 && exp_size >= 0
7483 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
7485 type = TREE_TYPE (value);
7487 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
7489 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
7490 (word_mode, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
7491 value = fold_convert (type, value);
7492 /* Make sure the bits beyond the original bitsize are zero
7493 so that we can correctly avoid extra zeroing stores in
7494 later constructor elements. */
7495 tree bitsize_mask
7496 = wide_int_to_tree (type, wi::mask (bitsize, false,
7497 BITS_PER_WORD));
7498 value = fold_build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, type, value, bitsize_mask);
7501 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
7502 value
7503 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
7504 build_int_cst (type,
7505 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
7506 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
7507 mode = word_mode;
7510 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
7511 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
7513 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
7514 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
7517 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
7518 0, bitregion_end, mode,
7519 value, cleared,
7520 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)),
7521 reverse);
7523 break;
7525 case ARRAY_TYPE:
7527 tree value, index;
7528 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
7529 bool need_to_clear;
7530 tree domain;
7531 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
7532 bool const_bounds_p;
7533 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
7534 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
7536 /* The storage order is specified for every aggregate type. */
7537 reverse = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type);
7539 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
7540 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
7541 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
7542 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
7543 && tree_fits_shwi_p (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)));
7545 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
7546 if (const_bounds_p)
7548 minelt = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain));
7549 maxelt = tree_to_shwi (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain));
7552 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
7553 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
7554 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
7555 if (cleared)
7556 need_to_clear = false;
7557 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
7558 need_to_clear = true;
7559 else
7561 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7562 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
7563 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
7565 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
7566 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
7567 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
7568 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
7570 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
7572 if (need_to_clear)
7573 break;
7575 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
7577 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
7578 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
7580 if (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (lo_index)
7581 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (hi_index))
7583 need_to_clear = true;
7584 break;
7587 this_node_count = (tree_to_uhwi (hi_index)
7588 - tree_to_uhwi (lo_index) + 1);
7590 else
7591 this_node_count = 1;
7593 count += this_node_count;
7594 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
7595 zero_count += this_node_count;
7598 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
7599 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
7600 75%. */
7601 if (! need_to_clear
7602 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
7603 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
7604 need_to_clear = true;
7607 if (need_to_clear && maybe_gt (size, 0))
7609 if (REG_P (target))
7610 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
7611 else
7612 clear_storage (target, gen_int_mode (size, Pmode),
7613 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7614 cleared = 1;
7617 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
7618 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
7619 emit_clobber (target);
7621 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
7622 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
7623 elements. */
7624 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
7626 machine_mode mode;
7627 poly_int64 bitsize;
7628 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
7629 rtx xtarget = target;
7631 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
7632 continue;
7634 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
7635 if (mode != BLKmode)
7636 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
7637 else if (!poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), &bitsize))
7638 bitsize = -1;
7640 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
7642 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
7643 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
7644 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
7645 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
7646 tree position;
7648 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
7649 if (const_bounds_p
7650 && tree_fits_shwi_p (lo_index)
7651 && tree_fits_shwi_p (hi_index)
7652 && (lo = tree_to_shwi (lo_index),
7653 hi = tree_to_shwi (hi_index),
7654 count = hi - lo + 1,
7655 (!MEM_P (target)
7656 || count <= 2
7657 || (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype))
7658 && (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)) * count
7659 <= 40 * 8)))))
7661 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
7662 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
7664 bitpos = lo * tree_to_shwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype));
7666 if (MEM_P (target)
7667 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
7668 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
7669 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
7671 target = copy_rtx (target);
7672 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
7675 store_constructor_field
7676 (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0, bitregion_end,
7677 mode, value, cleared,
7678 get_alias_set (elttype), reverse);
7681 else
7683 rtx_code_label *loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
7684 rtx_code_label *loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
7685 tree exit_cond;
7687 expand_normal (hi_index);
7689 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
7690 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
7691 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
7692 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
7693 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false, reverse);
7695 /* Build the head of the loop. */
7696 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
7697 emit_label (loop_start);
7699 /* Assign value to element index. */
7700 position =
7701 fold_convert (ssizetype,
7702 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
7703 TREE_TYPE (index),
7704 index,
7705 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
7707 position =
7708 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
7709 fold_convert (ssizetype,
7710 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
7712 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
7713 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
7714 highest_pow2_factor (position));
7715 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
7716 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7717 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
7718 exact_div (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT),
7719 reverse);
7720 else
7721 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false, reverse);
7723 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
7724 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
7725 index, hi_index);
7726 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end,
7727 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
7729 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
7730 the loop. */
7731 expand_assignment (index,
7732 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
7733 index, integer_one_node),
7734 false);
7736 emit_jump (loop_start);
7738 /* Build the end of the loop. */
7739 emit_label (loop_end);
7742 else if ((index != 0 && ! tree_fits_shwi_p (index))
7743 || ! tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)))
7745 tree position;
7747 if (index == 0)
7748 index = ssize_int (1);
7750 if (minelt)
7751 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
7752 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
7753 TREE_TYPE (index),
7754 index,
7755 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
7757 position =
7758 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
7759 fold_convert (ssizetype,
7760 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
7761 xtarget = offset_address (target,
7762 expand_normal (position),
7763 highest_pow2_factor (position));
7764 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
7765 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false, reverse);
7767 else
7769 if (index != 0)
7770 bitpos = ((tree_to_shwi (index) - minelt)
7771 * tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
7772 else
7773 bitpos = (i * tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (elttype)));
7775 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
7776 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
7777 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
7779 target = copy_rtx (target);
7780 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
7782 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0,
7783 bitregion_end, mode, value,
7784 cleared, get_alias_set (elttype),
7785 reverse);
7788 break;
7791 case VECTOR_TYPE:
7793 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7794 constructor_elt *ce;
7795 int i;
7796 bool need_to_clear;
7797 insn_code icode = CODE_FOR_nothing;
7798 tree elt;
7799 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
7800 int elt_size = vector_element_bits (type);
7801 machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
7802 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
7803 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
7804 rtvec vector = NULL;
7805 poly_uint64 n_elts;
7806 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT const_n_elts;
7807 alias_set_type alias;
7808 bool vec_vec_init_p = false;
7809 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
7811 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
7813 /* Try using vec_duplicate_optab for uniform vectors. */
7814 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp)
7815 && VECTOR_MODE_P (mode)
7816 && eltmode == GET_MODE_INNER (mode)
7817 && ((icode = optab_handler (vec_duplicate_optab, mode))
7818 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7819 && (elt = uniform_vector_p (exp))
7820 && !VECTOR_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (elt)))
7822 class expand_operand ops[2];
7823 create_output_operand (&ops[0], target, mode);
7824 create_input_operand (&ops[1], expand_normal (elt), eltmode);
7825 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
7826 if (!rtx_equal_p (target, ops[0].value))
7827 emit_move_insn (target, ops[0].value);
7828 break;
7830 /* Use sign-extension for uniform boolean vectors with
7831 integer modes. Effectively "vec_duplicate" for bitmasks. */
7832 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp)
7833 && VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (type)
7834 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode)
7835 && (elt = uniform_vector_p (exp))
7836 && !VECTOR_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (elt)))
7838 rtx op0 = force_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (elt)),
7839 expand_normal (elt));
7840 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
7841 convert_move (tmp, op0, 0);
7843 /* Ensure no excess bits are set.
7844 GCN needs this for nunits < 64.
7845 x86 needs this for nunits < 8. */
7846 auto nunits = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type).to_constant ();
7847 if (maybe_ne (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode), nunits))
7848 tmp = expand_binop (mode, and_optab, tmp,
7849 GEN_INT ((1 << nunits) - 1), target,
7850 true, OPTAB_WIDEN);
7851 if (tmp != target)
7852 emit_move_insn (target, tmp);
7853 break;
7856 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
7857 if (REG_P (target)
7858 && VECTOR_MODE_P (mode)
7859 && n_elts.is_constant (&const_n_elts))
7861 machine_mode emode = eltmode;
7862 bool vector_typed_elts_p = false;
7864 if (CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp)
7865 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (exp, 0)->value))
7866 == VECTOR_TYPE))
7868 tree etype = TREE_TYPE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (exp, 0)->value);
7869 gcc_assert (known_eq (CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp)
7870 * TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (etype),
7871 n_elts));
7872 emode = TYPE_MODE (etype);
7873 vector_typed_elts_p = true;
7875 icode = convert_optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode, emode);
7876 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
7878 unsigned int n = const_n_elts;
7880 if (vector_typed_elts_p)
7882 n = CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp);
7883 vec_vec_init_p = true;
7885 vector = rtvec_alloc (n);
7886 for (unsigned int k = 0; k < n; k++)
7887 RTVEC_ELT (vector, k) = CONST0_RTX (emode);
7891 /* Compute the size of the elements in the CTOR. It differs
7892 from the size of the vector type elements only when the
7893 CTOR elements are vectors themselves. */
7894 tree val_type = (CONSTRUCTOR_NELTS (exp) != 0
7895 ? TREE_TYPE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (exp, 0)->value)
7896 : elttype);
7897 if (VECTOR_TYPE_P (val_type))
7898 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (val_type));
7899 else
7900 bitsize = elt_size;
7902 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
7903 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
7904 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
7905 if (cleared)
7906 need_to_clear = false;
7907 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
7908 need_to_clear = true;
7909 else
7911 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
7912 tree value;
7914 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
7916 int n_elts_here = bitsize / elt_size;
7917 count += n_elts_here;
7918 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
7919 zero_count += n_elts_here;
7922 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
7923 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
7924 need_to_clear = (maybe_lt (count, n_elts)
7925 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
7928 if (need_to_clear && maybe_gt (size, 0) && !vector)
7930 if (REG_P (target))
7931 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (mode));
7932 else
7933 clear_storage (target, gen_int_mode (size, Pmode),
7934 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7935 cleared = 1;
7938 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
7939 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target) && maybe_gt (n_elts, 1u))
7941 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (mode));
7942 cleared = 1;
7945 if (MEM_P (target))
7946 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
7947 else
7948 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
7950 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
7951 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
7952 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
7953 vec_safe_iterate (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, &ce);
7954 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
7956 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
7957 tree value = ce->value;
7959 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
7960 continue;
7962 if (ce->index)
7963 eltpos = tree_to_uhwi (ce->index);
7964 else
7965 eltpos = i;
7967 if (vector)
7969 if (vec_vec_init_p)
7971 gcc_assert (ce->index == NULL_TREE);
7972 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE);
7973 eltpos = idx;
7975 else
7976 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
7977 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos) = expand_normal (value);
7979 else
7981 machine_mode value_mode
7982 = (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
7983 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) : eltmode);
7984 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
7985 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0,
7986 bitregion_end, value_mode,
7987 value, cleared, alias, reverse);
7991 if (vector)
7992 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (target,
7993 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (mode, vector)));
7994 break;
7997 default:
7998 gcc_unreachable ();
8002 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
8003 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
8004 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
8005 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
8007 BITREGION_START is bitpos of the first bitfield in this region.
8008 BITREGION_END is the bitpos of the ending bitfield in this region.
8009 These two fields are 0, if the C++ memory model does not apply,
8010 or we are not interested in keeping track of bitfield regions.
8012 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
8013 return.
8015 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
8016 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
8017 reference to the containing structure.
8019 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store.
8021 If REVERSE is true, the store is to be done in reverse order. */
8023 static rtx
8024 store_field (rtx target, poly_int64 bitsize, poly_int64 bitpos,
8025 poly_uint64 bitregion_start, poly_uint64 bitregion_end,
8026 machine_mode mode, tree exp,
8027 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal, bool reverse)
8029 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
8030 return const0_rtx;
8032 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
8033 side-effects. Don't do that for zero sized addressable lhs of
8034 calls. */
8035 if (known_eq (bitsize, 0)
8036 && (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8037 || TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR))
8038 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8040 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
8042 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
8044 gcc_assert (known_eq (bitpos, 0));
8045 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal, reverse);
8048 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
8049 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
8050 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
8052 poly_int64 decl_bitsize;
8053 if (mode == VOIDmode
8054 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
8055 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
8056 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
8057 || REG_P (target)
8058 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
8059 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
8060 store it as a bit field. */
8061 || (mode != BLKmode
8062 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
8063 || !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
8064 && targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
8065 || !multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)))
8066 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
8067 && mode != BLKmode
8068 && maybe_gt (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), bitsize))
8069 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
8070 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
8071 operations. */
8072 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
8073 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
8074 && maybe_ne (wi::to_poly_offset (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))),
8075 bitsize)
8076 /* Except for initialization of full bytes from a CONSTRUCTOR, which
8077 we will handle specially below. */
8078 && !(TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
8079 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
8080 /* And except for bitwise copying of TREE_ADDRESSABLE types,
8081 where the FIELD_DECL has the right bitsize, but TREE_TYPE (exp)
8082 includes some extra padding. store_expr / expand_expr will in
8083 that case call get_inner_reference that will have the bitsize
8084 we check here and thus the block move will not clobber the
8085 padding that shouldn't be clobbered. In the future we could
8086 replace the TREE_ADDRESSABLE check with a check that
8087 get_base_address needs to live in memory. */
8088 && (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8089 || TREE_CODE (exp) != COMPONENT_REF
8090 || !multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT)
8091 || !multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)
8092 || !poly_int_tree_p (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
8093 &decl_bitsize)
8094 || maybe_ne (decl_bitsize, bitsize))
8095 /* A call with an addressable return type and return-slot
8096 optimization must not need bitfield operations but we must
8097 pass down the original target. */
8098 && (TREE_CODE (exp) != CALL_EXPR
8099 || !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8100 || !CALL_EXPR_RETURN_SLOT_OPT (exp)))
8101 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
8102 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
8103 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
8104 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
8105 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
8106 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
8107 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
8108 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
8110 rtx temp;
8111 gimple *nop_def;
8113 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
8114 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
8115 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
8116 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
8117 C front end. */
8118 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
8119 if (nop_def)
8121 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
8122 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
8123 && maybe_ne (TYPE_PRECISION (type),
8124 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8125 && known_eq (bitsize, TYPE_PRECISION (type)))
8127 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
8128 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
8129 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
8130 && known_ge (TYPE_PRECISION (type), bitsize))
8131 exp = op;
8135 temp = expand_normal (exp);
8137 /* We don't support variable-sized BLKmode bitfields, since our
8138 handling of BLKmode is bound up with the ability to break
8139 things into words. */
8140 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode || bitsize.is_constant ());
8142 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
8143 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
8144 if (GET_CODE (temp) == PARALLEL)
8146 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8147 machine_mode temp_mode = GET_MODE (temp);
8148 if (temp_mode == BLKmode || temp_mode == VOIDmode)
8149 temp_mode = smallest_int_mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT);
8150 rtx temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (temp_mode);
8151 emit_group_store (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp), size);
8152 temp = temp_target;
8155 /* Handle calls that return BLKmode values in registers. */
8156 else if (mode == BLKmode && REG_P (temp) && TREE_CODE (exp) == CALL_EXPR)
8158 rtx temp_target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (temp));
8159 copy_blkmode_from_reg (temp_target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp));
8160 temp = temp_target;
8163 /* If the value has aggregate type and an integral mode then, if BITSIZE
8164 is narrower than this mode and this is for big-endian data, we first
8165 need to put the value into the low-order bits for store_bit_field,
8166 except when MODE is BLKmode and BITSIZE larger than the word size
8167 (see the handling of fields larger than a word in store_bit_field).
8168 Moreover, the field may be not aligned on a byte boundary; in this
8169 case, if it has reverse storage order, it needs to be accessed as a
8170 scalar field with reverse storage order and we must first put the
8171 value into target order. */
8172 scalar_int_mode temp_mode;
8173 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8174 && is_int_mode (GET_MODE (temp), &temp_mode))
8176 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (temp_mode);
8178 reverse = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8180 if (reverse)
8181 temp = flip_storage_order (temp_mode, temp);
8183 gcc_checking_assert (known_le (bitsize, size));
8184 if (maybe_lt (bitsize, size)
8185 && reverse ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
8186 /* Use of to_constant for BLKmode was checked above. */
8187 && !(mode == BLKmode && bitsize.to_constant () > BITS_PER_WORD))
8188 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, temp_mode, temp,
8189 size - bitsize, NULL_RTX, 1);
8192 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to MODE. */
8193 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
8194 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
8195 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
8197 /* If the mode of TEMP and TARGET is BLKmode, both must be in memory
8198 and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte boundary. If so, we simply do
8199 a block copy. Likewise for a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
8200 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
8201 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
8202 || (MEM_P (target)
8203 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
8204 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)
8205 && multiple_p (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))))
8207 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp));
8208 poly_int64 bytepos = exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT);
8209 poly_int64 bytesize = bits_to_bytes_round_up (bitsize);
8211 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bytepos);
8212 emit_block_move (target, temp,
8213 gen_int_mode (bytesize, Pmode),
8214 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
8216 return const0_rtx;
8219 /* If the mode of TEMP is still BLKmode and BITSIZE not larger than the
8220 word size, we need to load the value (see again store_bit_field). */
8221 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && known_le (bitsize, BITS_PER_WORD))
8223 temp_mode = smallest_int_mode_for_size (bitsize);
8224 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, bitsize, 0, 1, NULL_RTX, temp_mode,
8225 temp_mode, false, NULL);
8228 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
8229 gcc_checking_assert (known_ge (bitpos, 0));
8230 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
8231 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
8232 mode, temp, reverse, false);
8234 return const0_rtx;
8236 else
8238 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
8239 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode,
8240 exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT));
8242 if (to_rtx == target)
8243 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
8245 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
8246 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
8248 /* Above we avoided using bitfield operations for storing a CONSTRUCTOR
8249 into a target smaller than its type; handle that case now. */
8250 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR && known_size_p (bitsize))
8252 poly_int64 bytesize = exact_div (bitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT);
8253 store_constructor (exp, to_rtx, 0, bytesize, reverse);
8254 return to_rtx;
8257 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal, reverse);
8261 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
8262 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
8263 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
8265 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
8266 bit position, *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness and *PREVERSEP to the
8267 storage order of the field.
8268 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
8269 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
8270 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
8271 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
8273 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
8274 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
8276 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
8277 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
8279 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
8280 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
8281 this case, but the address of the object can be found. */
8283 tree
8284 get_inner_reference (tree exp, poly_int64 *pbitsize,
8285 poly_int64 *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
8286 machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
8287 int *preversep, int *pvolatilep)
8289 tree size_tree = 0;
8290 machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
8291 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
8292 tree offset = size_zero_node;
8293 poly_offset_int bit_offset = 0;
8295 /* First get the mode, signedness, storage order and size. We do this from
8296 just the outermost expression. */
8297 *pbitsize = -1;
8298 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
8300 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8301 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
8302 if (flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0
8303 && TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
8304 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field)
8305 && DECL_MODE (field) != BLKmode)
8306 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
8307 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
8308 size. */
8309 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
8310 else if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
8312 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
8313 /* For vector fields re-check the target flags, as DECL_MODE
8314 could have been set with different target flags than
8315 the current function has. */
8316 if (VECTOR_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (field))
8317 && VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE_RAW (TREE_TYPE (field))))
8318 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
8320 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
8321 blkmode_bitfield = true;
8323 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
8325 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
8327 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8328 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8329 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
8331 /* For vector element types with the correct size of access or for
8332 vector typed accesses use the mode of the access type. */
8333 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
8334 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
8335 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
8336 || VECTOR_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
8337 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8339 else
8341 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8342 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8344 if (mode == BLKmode)
8345 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
8346 else
8347 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
8350 if (size_tree != 0)
8352 if (! tree_fits_uhwi_p (size_tree))
8353 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
8354 else
8355 *pbitsize = tree_to_uhwi (size_tree);
8358 *preversep = reverse_storage_order_for_component_p (exp);
8360 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
8361 and find the ultimate containing object. */
8362 while (1)
8364 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
8366 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8367 bit_offset += wi::to_poly_offset (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
8368 break;
8370 case COMPONENT_REF:
8372 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8373 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
8375 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
8376 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
8377 type construction. */
8378 if (this_offset == 0)
8379 break;
8381 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
8382 bit_offset += wi::to_poly_offset (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
8384 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
8386 break;
8388 case ARRAY_REF:
8389 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
8391 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8392 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
8393 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
8395 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
8396 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
8397 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
8398 the array element. */
8399 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
8400 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
8401 index, low_bound);
8403 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
8404 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
8405 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
8406 unit_size));
8408 break;
8410 case REALPART_EXPR:
8411 break;
8413 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
8414 bit_offset += *pbitsize;
8415 break;
8417 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
8418 break;
8420 case MEM_REF:
8421 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
8422 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
8424 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8425 if (!integer_zerop (off))
8427 poly_offset_int boff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
8428 boff <<= LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT;
8429 bit_offset += boff;
8431 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
8433 goto done;
8435 default:
8436 goto done;
8439 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
8440 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
8441 *pvolatilep = 1;
8443 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8445 done:
8447 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
8448 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
8449 this conversion. */
8450 if (poly_int_tree_p (offset))
8452 poly_offset_int tem = wi::sext (wi::to_poly_offset (offset),
8453 TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype));
8454 tem <<= LOG2_BITS_PER_UNIT;
8455 tem += bit_offset;
8456 if (tem.to_shwi (pbitpos))
8457 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
8460 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
8461 if (offset)
8463 /* Avoid returning a negative bitpos as this may wreak havoc later. */
8464 if (!bit_offset.to_shwi (pbitpos) || maybe_lt (*pbitpos, 0))
8466 *pbitpos = num_trailing_bits (bit_offset.force_shwi ());
8467 poly_offset_int bytes = bits_to_bytes_round_down (bit_offset);
8468 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
8469 build_int_cst (sizetype, bytes.force_shwi ()));
8472 *poffset = offset;
8475 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
8476 if (mode == VOIDmode
8477 && blkmode_bitfield
8478 && multiple_p (*pbitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)
8479 && multiple_p (*pbitsize, BITS_PER_UNIT))
8480 *pmode = BLKmode;
8481 else
8482 *pmode = mode;
8484 return exp;
8487 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
8489 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8490 target_align (const_tree target)
8492 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
8493 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
8495 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
8497 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
8499 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
8500 return 1;
8502 case COMPONENT_REF:
8503 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
8504 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
8505 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
8507 case ARRAY_REF:
8508 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
8509 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
8510 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
8511 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
8513 CASE_CONVERT:
8514 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
8515 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
8516 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
8517 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
8518 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
8520 default:
8521 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
8526 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
8527 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
8528 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
8529 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
8531 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
8534 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
8536 rtx op1, op2;
8537 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
8538 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
8539 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
8541 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
8542 if (code == SUBREG
8543 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
8544 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
8546 value
8547 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
8548 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
8549 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
8550 NULL_RTX)),
8551 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
8552 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
8553 code = GET_CODE (value);
8556 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
8557 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
8558 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
8559 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
8560 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
8561 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
8563 if (!subtarget)
8564 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
8565 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
8566 return subtarget;
8569 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
8571 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
8572 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
8573 subtarget = 0;
8574 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
8576 code = PLUS;
8577 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
8580 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
8581 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
8582 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
8583 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
8584 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
8585 creating another one around this addition. */
8586 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
8587 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
8588 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
8589 && VIRTUAL_REGISTER_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)))
8591 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
8592 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
8593 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8594 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
8595 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
8596 0), 1), 0),
8597 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8600 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
8601 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
8602 switch (code)
8604 case MULT:
8605 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
8606 case DIV:
8607 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
8608 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
8609 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8610 else
8611 return expand_divmod (0,
8612 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
8613 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
8614 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
8615 case MOD:
8616 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
8617 target, 0);
8618 case UDIV:
8619 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
8620 target, 1);
8621 case UMOD:
8622 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
8623 target, 1);
8624 case ASHIFTRT:
8625 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
8626 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8627 default:
8628 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
8629 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8632 if (UNARY_P (value))
8634 if (!target)
8635 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
8636 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
8637 switch (code)
8639 case ZERO_EXTEND:
8640 case SIGN_EXTEND:
8641 case TRUNCATE:
8642 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
8643 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
8644 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
8645 return target;
8647 case FIX:
8648 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
8649 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
8650 return target;
8652 case FLOAT:
8653 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
8654 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
8655 return target;
8657 default:
8658 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
8662 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
8663 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
8664 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
8665 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (value) && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
8666 value
8667 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
8668 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
8669 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
8670 NULL_RTX)),
8671 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
8672 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
8673 #endif
8675 return value;
8678 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return true iff there is no way that
8679 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
8680 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
8681 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
8683 It is always safe for this routine to return false since it merely
8684 searches for optimization opportunities. */
8686 bool
8687 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
8689 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
8690 int i, nops;
8692 if (x == 0
8693 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
8694 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
8695 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
8696 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
8697 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
8698 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
8699 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
8700 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
8701 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
8702 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
8703 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
8704 != INTEGER_CST)
8705 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
8706 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
8707 || (MEM_P (x)
8708 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
8709 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
8710 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
8711 return true;
8713 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
8714 find the underlying pseudo. */
8715 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
8717 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
8718 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8719 return false;
8722 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
8723 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
8725 case tcc_declaration:
8726 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
8727 break;
8729 case tcc_constant:
8730 return true;
8732 case tcc_exceptional:
8733 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
8735 while (1)
8737 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
8738 return false;
8739 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
8740 if (!exp)
8741 return true;
8742 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
8743 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
8746 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
8748 constructor_elt *ce;
8749 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
8751 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce)
8752 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
8753 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
8754 return false;
8755 return true;
8757 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
8758 return true; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
8759 else
8760 return false;
8762 case tcc_statement:
8763 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
8764 DECL_EXPR. */
8765 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
8766 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
8767 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
8768 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
8770 case tcc_binary:
8771 case tcc_comparison:
8772 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
8773 return false;
8774 /* Fall through. */
8776 case tcc_unary:
8777 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
8779 case tcc_expression:
8780 case tcc_reference:
8781 case tcc_vl_exp:
8782 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
8783 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
8784 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
8785 expression recursively. */
8787 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
8789 case ADDR_EXPR:
8790 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
8791 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
8792 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
8793 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
8794 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
8795 return true;
8797 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
8798 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
8799 very rare. */
8800 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8801 if (DECL_P (exp))
8803 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
8804 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
8805 return false;
8806 else
8807 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
8809 break;
8811 case MEM_REF:
8812 if (MEM_P (x)
8813 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
8814 get_alias_set (exp)))
8815 return false;
8816 break;
8818 case CALL_EXPR:
8819 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
8820 all of memory. */
8821 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8822 || MEM_P (x))
8823 return false;
8824 break;
8826 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
8827 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
8828 /* Lowered by gimplify.cc. */
8829 gcc_unreachable ();
8831 case SAVE_EXPR:
8832 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
8834 default:
8835 break;
8838 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
8839 if (exp_rtl)
8840 break;
8842 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
8843 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
8844 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
8845 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
8846 return false;
8848 break;
8850 case tcc_type:
8851 /* Should never get a type here. */
8852 gcc_unreachable ();
8855 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
8856 with it. */
8857 if (exp_rtl)
8859 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
8861 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
8862 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
8863 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8864 return false;
8867 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
8868 are memory and they conflict. */
8869 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
8870 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
8871 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x)));
8874 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
8875 return true;
8879 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
8880 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
8882 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8883 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
8885 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ret;
8886 int trailing_zeros = tree_ctz (exp);
8887 if (trailing_zeros >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8888 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
8889 ret = HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << trailing_zeros;
8890 if (ret > BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
8891 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
8892 return ret;
8895 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
8896 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
8897 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
8898 the structure gives the alignment. */
8900 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
8901 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
8903 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
8904 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
8906 return MAX (factor, talign);
8909 /* Convert the tree comparison code TCODE to the rtl one where the
8910 signedness is UNSIGNEDP. */
8912 static enum rtx_code
8913 convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (enum tree_code tcode, int unsignedp)
8915 enum rtx_code code;
8916 switch (tcode)
8918 case EQ_EXPR:
8919 code = EQ;
8920 break;
8921 case NE_EXPR:
8922 code = NE;
8923 break;
8924 case LT_EXPR:
8925 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
8926 break;
8927 case LE_EXPR:
8928 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8929 break;
8930 case GT_EXPR:
8931 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
8932 break;
8933 case GE_EXPR:
8934 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
8935 break;
8936 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8937 code = UNORDERED;
8938 break;
8939 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8940 code = ORDERED;
8941 break;
8942 case UNLT_EXPR:
8943 code = UNLT;
8944 break;
8945 case UNLE_EXPR:
8946 code = UNLE;
8947 break;
8948 case UNGT_EXPR:
8949 code = UNGT;
8950 break;
8951 case UNGE_EXPR:
8952 code = UNGE;
8953 break;
8954 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8955 code = UNEQ;
8956 break;
8957 case LTGT_EXPR:
8958 code = LTGT;
8959 break;
8961 default:
8962 gcc_unreachable ();
8964 return code;
8967 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
8968 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
8969 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
8970 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
8972 void
8973 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
8974 enum expand_modifier modifier)
8976 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
8977 target = 0;
8978 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
8980 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
8981 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
8983 else
8985 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
8986 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8991 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
8992 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
8994 static rtx
8995 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
8997 rtx mem;
8999 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
9000 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9001 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
9002 return mem;
9005 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
9006 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
9008 static rtx
9009 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, scalar_int_mode tmode,
9010 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
9012 rtx result, subtarget;
9013 tree inner, offset;
9014 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos;
9015 int unsignedp, reversep, volatilep = 0;
9016 machine_mode mode1;
9018 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
9019 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
9020 at top level. */
9021 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
9022 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
9023 exception here is STRING_CST. */
9024 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
9026 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
9027 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
9028 result = force_operand (result, target);
9029 return result;
9032 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
9033 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
9035 case INDIRECT_REF:
9036 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
9037 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
9039 case MEM_REF:
9041 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9042 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9043 tem = fold_build_pointer_plus (tem, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
9044 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
9047 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
9048 return addr_for_mem_ref (exp, as, true);
9050 case CONST_DECL:
9051 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
9052 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp),
9053 0, modifier), 0);
9054 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
9055 result = force_operand (result, target);
9056 return result;
9058 case REALPART_EXPR:
9059 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
9060 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
9061 offset = 0;
9062 bitpos = 0;
9063 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9064 break;
9066 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
9067 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
9068 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
9069 scalar type. */
9070 offset = 0;
9071 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (SCALAR_TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9072 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9073 break;
9075 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
9076 /* Allow COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR in initializers or coming from
9077 initializers, if e.g. rtl_for_decl_init is called on DECL_INITIAL
9078 with COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPRs in it, or ARRAY_REF on a const static
9079 array with address of COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR in DECL_INITIAL;
9080 the initializers aren't gimplified. */
9081 if (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp)
9082 && is_global_var (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp)))
9083 return expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp),
9084 target, tmode, modifier, as);
9085 /* FALLTHRU */
9086 default:
9087 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
9088 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
9089 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
9090 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
9091 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
9092 be expanded in some interesting way. */
9093 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
9094 if (DECL_P (exp)
9095 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
9096 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
9098 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
9099 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9100 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
9102 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
9103 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
9104 or a tree optimizer bug. */
9106 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
9107 result = XEXP (result, 0);
9109 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
9110 if (DECL_P (exp))
9111 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
9113 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9114 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9115 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
9116 result = force_operand (result, target);
9117 return result;
9120 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
9121 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
9122 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
9123 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
9124 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
9125 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
9126 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
9127 break;
9130 /* We must have made progress. */
9131 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
9133 subtarget = offset || maybe_ne (bitpos, 0) ? NULL_RTX : target;
9134 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
9135 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
9136 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
9137 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
9139 inner = copy_node (inner);
9140 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
9141 SET_TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner), TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9142 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
9144 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
9146 if (offset)
9148 rtx tmp;
9150 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
9151 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
9152 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
9153 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9154 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
9156 /* expand_expr is allowed to return an object in a mode other
9157 than TMODE. If it did, we need to convert. */
9158 if (GET_MODE (tmp) != VOIDmode && tmode != GET_MODE (tmp))
9159 tmp = convert_modes (tmode, GET_MODE (tmp),
9160 tmp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (offset)));
9161 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
9162 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
9164 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9165 result = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode, result, tmp);
9166 else
9168 subtarget = maybe_ne (bitpos, 0) ? NULL_RTX : target;
9169 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
9170 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
9174 if (maybe_ne (bitpos, 0))
9176 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
9177 of an object that isn't byte-aligned. */
9178 poly_int64 bytepos = exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT);
9179 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
9180 result = plus_constant (tmode, result, bytepos);
9181 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
9182 result = force_operand (result, target);
9185 return result;
9188 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
9189 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
9191 static rtx
9192 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
9193 enum expand_modifier modifier)
9195 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
9196 scalar_int_mode address_mode = Pmode;
9197 scalar_int_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
9198 machine_mode rmode;
9199 rtx result;
9201 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
9202 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
9203 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
9205 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
9207 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9208 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
9209 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
9212 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
9213 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
9214 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
9215 scalar_int_mode new_tmode = (tmode == pointer_mode
9216 ? pointer_mode
9217 : address_mode);
9219 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
9220 new_tmode, modifier, as);
9222 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
9223 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
9224 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
9225 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
9226 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
9227 rmode = new_tmode;
9228 if (rmode != new_tmode)
9229 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (new_tmode, result, as);
9231 return result;
9234 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
9235 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
9236 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
9237 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
9239 static rtx
9240 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
9241 bool avoid_temp_mem)
9243 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9244 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9246 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
9247 if all of the initializer is zero.
9248 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
9249 with memset. */
9250 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
9251 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
9252 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
9253 && all_zeros_p (exp))
9255 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
9256 return target;
9259 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
9260 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
9261 since that should make a CONST_INT, CONST_WIDE_INT or
9262 CONST_DOUBLE when we fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can
9263 use, it is best to store directly into the target unless the type
9264 is large enough that memcpy will be used. If we are making an
9265 initializer and all operands are constant, put it in memory as
9266 well.
9268 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
9269 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
9270 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
9271 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
9272 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
9273 && ((mode == BLKmode
9274 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
9275 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
9276 || (tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type))
9277 && (! can_move_by_pieces
9278 (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)),
9279 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
9280 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
9281 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
9282 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
9284 rtx constructor;
9286 if (avoid_temp_mem)
9287 return NULL_RTX;
9289 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
9291 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9292 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9293 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
9294 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
9296 return constructor;
9299 /* If the CTOR is available in static storage and not mostly
9300 zeros and we can move it by pieces prefer to do so since
9301 that's usually more efficient than performing a series of
9302 stores from immediates. */
9303 if (avoid_temp_mem
9304 && TREE_STATIC (exp)
9305 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)
9306 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type))
9307 && can_move_by_pieces (tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type)),
9308 TYPE_ALIGN (type))
9309 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))
9310 return NULL_RTX;
9312 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
9313 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
9314 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
9315 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9316 /* Also make a temporary if the store is to volatile memory, to
9317 avoid individual accesses to aggregate members. */
9318 || (GET_CODE (target) == MEM
9319 && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target)
9320 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
9322 if (avoid_temp_mem)
9323 return NULL_RTX;
9325 target = assign_temp (type, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
9328 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp), false);
9329 return target;
9333 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
9334 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
9335 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
9337 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
9338 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
9339 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
9341 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
9343 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
9344 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
9345 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
9346 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
9347 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
9349 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
9350 probably will not be used.
9352 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
9353 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
9354 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
9355 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
9356 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
9357 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
9359 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
9360 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
9361 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
9362 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
9364 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
9365 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
9366 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
9368 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
9369 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
9370 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
9371 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
9372 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
9373 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
9375 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
9376 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
9377 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
9378 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
9379 recursively.
9380 If the result can be stored at TARGET, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL,
9381 then *ALT_RTL is set to TARGET (before legitimziation).
9383 If INNER_REFERENCE_P is true, we are expanding an inner reference.
9384 In this case, we don't adjust a returned MEM rtx that wouldn't be
9385 sufficiently aligned for its mode; instead, it's up to the caller
9386 to deal with it afterwards. This is used to make sure that unaligned
9387 base objects for which out-of-bounds accesses are supported, for
9388 example record types with trailing arrays, aren't realigned behind
9389 the back of the caller.
9390 The normal operating mode is to pass FALSE for this parameter. */
9393 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
9394 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl,
9395 bool inner_reference_p)
9397 rtx ret;
9399 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
9400 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
9401 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
9403 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
9404 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
9407 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
9408 inner_reference_p);
9409 return ret;
9412 /* Try to expand the conditional expression which is represented by
9413 TREEOP0 ? TREEOP1 : TREEOP2 using conditonal moves. If it succeeds
9414 return the rtl reg which represents the result. Otherwise return
9415 NULL_RTX. */
9417 static rtx
9418 expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (tree treeop0 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9419 tree treeop1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
9420 tree treeop2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
9422 rtx insn;
9423 rtx op00, op01, op1, op2;
9424 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
9425 machine_mode comparison_mode;
9426 gimple *srcstmt;
9427 rtx temp;
9428 tree type = TREE_TYPE (treeop1);
9429 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9430 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9431 machine_mode orig_mode = mode;
9432 static bool expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove = false;
9434 /* Conditional move expansion can end up TERing two operands which,
9435 when recursively hitting conditional expressions can result in
9436 exponential behavior if the cmove expansion ultimatively fails.
9437 It's hardly profitable to TER a cmove into a cmove so avoid doing
9438 that by failing early if we end up recursing. */
9439 if (expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove)
9440 return NULL_RTX;
9442 /* If we cannot do a conditional move on the mode, try doing it
9443 with the promoted mode. */
9444 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
9446 mode = promote_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp);
9447 if (!can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
9448 return NULL_RTX;
9449 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0); /* Use promoted mode for temp. */
9451 else
9452 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
9454 expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove = true;
9455 start_sequence ();
9456 expand_operands (treeop1, treeop2,
9457 mode == orig_mode ? temp : NULL_RTX, &op1, &op2,
9458 EXPAND_NORMAL);
9460 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME
9461 && (srcstmt = get_def_for_expr_class (treeop0, tcc_comparison)))
9463 type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
9464 enum tree_code cmpcode = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
9465 op00 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt));
9466 op01 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
9467 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9468 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9469 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
9471 else if (COMPARISON_CLASS_P (treeop0))
9473 type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
9474 enum tree_code cmpcode = TREE_CODE (treeop0);
9475 op00 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0));
9476 op01 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1));
9477 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9478 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9479 comparison_code = convert_tree_comp_to_rtx (cmpcode, unsignedp);
9481 else
9483 op00 = expand_normal (treeop0);
9484 op01 = const0_rtx;
9485 comparison_code = NE;
9486 comparison_mode = GET_MODE (op00);
9487 if (comparison_mode == VOIDmode)
9488 comparison_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9490 expanding_cond_expr_using_cmove = false;
9492 if (GET_MODE (op1) != mode)
9493 op1 = gen_lowpart (mode, op1);
9495 if (GET_MODE (op2) != mode)
9496 op2 = gen_lowpart (mode, op2);
9498 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
9499 insn = emit_conditional_move (temp,
9500 { comparison_code, op00, op01,
9501 comparison_mode },
9502 op1, op2, mode,
9503 unsignedp);
9505 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
9506 and return. */
9507 if (insn)
9509 rtx_insn *seq = get_insns ();
9510 end_sequence ();
9511 emit_insn (seq);
9512 return convert_modes (orig_mode, mode, temp, 0);
9515 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
9516 branches. */
9517 end_sequence ();
9518 return NULL_RTX;
9521 /* A helper function for expand_expr_real_2 to be used with a
9522 misaligned mem_ref TEMP. Assume an unsigned type if UNSIGNEDP
9523 is nonzero, with alignment ALIGN in bits.
9524 Store the value at TARGET if possible (if TARGET is nonzero).
9525 Regardless of TARGET, we return the rtx for where the value is placed.
9526 If the result can be stored at TARGET, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL,
9527 then *ALT_RTL is set to TARGET (before legitimziation). */
9529 static rtx
9530 expand_misaligned_mem_ref (rtx temp, machine_mode mode, int unsignedp,
9531 unsigned int align, rtx target, rtx *alt_rtl)
9533 enum insn_code icode;
9535 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9536 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
9538 class expand_operand ops[2];
9540 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9541 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9542 nor can the generator. */
9543 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9544 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9545 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9546 temp = ops[0].value;
9548 else if (targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode, align))
9549 temp = extract_bit_field (temp, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
9550 0, unsignedp, target,
9551 mode, mode, false, alt_rtl);
9552 return temp;
9555 /* Helper function of expand_expr_2, expand a division or modulo.
9556 op0 and op1 should be already expanded treeop0 and treeop1, using
9557 expand_operands. */
9559 static rtx
9560 expand_expr_divmod (tree_code code, machine_mode mode, tree treeop0,
9561 tree treeop1, rtx op0, rtx op1, rtx target, int unsignedp)
9563 bool mod_p = (code == TRUNC_MOD_EXPR || code == FLOOR_MOD_EXPR
9564 || code == CEIL_MOD_EXPR || code == ROUND_MOD_EXPR);
9565 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode)
9566 && optimize >= 2
9567 && get_range_pos_neg (treeop0) == 1
9568 && get_range_pos_neg (treeop1) == 1)
9570 /* If both arguments are known to be positive when interpreted
9571 as signed, we can expand it as both signed and unsigned
9572 division or modulo. Choose the cheaper sequence in that case. */
9573 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
9574 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
9575 start_sequence ();
9576 rtx uns_ret = expand_divmod (mod_p, code, mode, op0, op1, target, 1);
9577 rtx_insn *uns_insns = get_insns ();
9578 end_sequence ();
9579 start_sequence ();
9580 rtx sgn_ret = expand_divmod (mod_p, code, mode, op0, op1, target, 0);
9581 rtx_insn *sgn_insns = get_insns ();
9582 end_sequence ();
9583 unsigned uns_cost = seq_cost (uns_insns, speed_p);
9584 unsigned sgn_cost = seq_cost (sgn_insns, speed_p);
9586 /* If costs are the same then use as tie breaker the other other
9587 factor. */
9588 if (uns_cost == sgn_cost)
9590 uns_cost = seq_cost (uns_insns, !speed_p);
9591 sgn_cost = seq_cost (sgn_insns, !speed_p);
9594 if (uns_cost < sgn_cost || (uns_cost == sgn_cost && unsignedp))
9596 emit_insn (uns_insns);
9597 return uns_ret;
9599 emit_insn (sgn_insns);
9600 return sgn_ret;
9602 return expand_divmod (mod_p, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
9606 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
9607 enum expand_modifier modifier)
9609 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
9610 rtx_code_label *lab;
9611 tree type;
9612 int unsignedp;
9613 machine_mode mode;
9614 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
9615 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
9616 optab this_optab;
9617 rtx subtarget, original_target;
9618 int ignore;
9619 bool reduce_bit_field;
9620 location_t loc = ops->location;
9621 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
9622 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
9623 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
9624 target, \
9625 type) \
9626 : (expr))
9628 type = ops->type;
9629 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9630 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
9632 treeop0 = ops->op0;
9633 treeop1 = ops->op1;
9634 treeop2 = ops->op2;
9636 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
9637 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
9638 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
9639 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
9640 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
9641 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
9643 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
9644 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
9645 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
9646 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
9648 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
9649 gcc_assert (!ignore);
9651 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
9652 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
9653 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
9654 reduce_bit_field = (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
9655 && !type_has_mode_precision_p (type));
9657 if (reduce_bit_field
9658 && (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9659 || (target && GET_MODE (target) != mode)))
9660 target = 0;
9662 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
9663 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
9664 original_target = target;
9666 switch (code)
9668 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9669 case PAREN_EXPR:
9670 CASE_CONVERT:
9671 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
9672 return const0_rtx;
9674 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
9676 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
9678 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
9679 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
9680 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
9682 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
9683 modifier);
9685 result = copy_rtx (result);
9686 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
9687 return result;
9690 if (target == 0)
9692 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
9693 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
9694 else
9695 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
9698 if (MEM_P (target))
9699 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
9700 store_expr (treeop0,
9701 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
9702 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
9703 false, TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type));
9705 else
9707 gcc_assert (REG_P (target)
9708 && !TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type));
9710 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
9711 poly_uint64 op0_size
9712 = tree_to_poly_uint64 (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
9713 poly_uint64 union_size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
9714 store_field (target,
9715 /* The conversion must be constructed so that
9716 we know at compile time how many bits
9717 to preserve. */
9718 ordered_min (op0_size, union_size),
9719 0, 0, 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0, 0,
9720 false, false);
9723 /* Return the entire union. */
9724 return target;
9727 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
9729 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
9730 modifier);
9732 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
9735 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
9736 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
9737 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
9740 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
9741 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
9743 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
9744 machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
9746 if (inner_mode == VOIDmode)
9747 inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
9749 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9750 op0 = lowpart_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode);
9751 else
9752 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
9753 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
9756 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9757 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
9758 ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
9760 else if (target == 0)
9761 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
9762 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
9763 (treeop0)));
9764 else
9766 convert_move (target, op0,
9767 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
9768 op0 = target;
9771 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
9773 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
9775 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
9777 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
9778 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
9780 addr_space_t as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
9781 addr_space_t as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
9783 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
9784 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
9785 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
9787 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9789 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
9790 to overlapping address spaces. */
9791 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
9792 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
9794 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
9796 else
9798 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but a null
9799 pointer invokes undefined behavior. We truncate or extend the
9800 value as if we'd converted via integers, which handles 0 as
9801 required, and all others as the programmer likely expects. */
9802 #ifndef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
9803 const int POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED = 1;
9804 #endif
9805 op0 = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (treeop0_type),
9806 op0, POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED);
9808 gcc_assert (op0);
9809 return op0;
9812 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
9813 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
9814 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
9815 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
9816 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
9817 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
9818 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
9819 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
9820 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
9821 treeop1));
9822 /* If sizetype precision is larger than pointer precision, truncate the
9823 offset to have matching modes. */
9824 else if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
9825 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop1);
9826 /* FALLTHRU */
9828 case PLUS_EXPR:
9829 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
9830 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
9831 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
9832 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
9833 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
9835 fold-const.cc will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
9836 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
9837 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
9838 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
9840 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
9841 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9842 && VAR_P (treeop1)
9843 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
9844 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
9845 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
9847 gcc_unreachable ();
9850 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
9851 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
9852 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
9853 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
9854 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
9855 address.
9857 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
9858 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9859 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
9861 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9862 target = 0;
9863 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
9864 && HWI_COMPUTABLE_MODE_P (mode)
9865 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
9867 rtx constant_part;
9868 HOST_WIDE_INT wc;
9869 machine_mode wmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1));
9871 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
9872 EXPAND_SUM);
9873 /* Use wi::shwi to ensure that the constant is
9874 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
9875 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
9876 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
9877 wc = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0);
9878 constant_part =
9879 immed_wide_int_const (wi::shwi (wc, wmode), wmode);
9880 op1 = plus_constant (mode, op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
9881 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9882 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
9883 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
9886 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
9887 && HWI_COMPUTABLE_MODE_P (mode)
9888 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
9890 rtx constant_part;
9891 HOST_WIDE_INT wc;
9892 machine_mode wmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
9894 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
9895 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9896 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
9897 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
9899 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
9900 VOIDmode, modifier);
9901 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
9902 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
9903 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9904 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
9905 goto binop2;
9907 /* Use wi::shwi to ensure that the constant is
9908 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
9909 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
9910 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
9911 wc = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1);
9912 constant_part
9913 = immed_wide_int_const (wi::shwi (wc, wmode), wmode);
9914 op0 = plus_constant (mode, op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
9915 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9916 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
9917 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
9921 /* Use TER to expand pointer addition of a negated value
9922 as pointer subtraction. */
9923 if ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
9924 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == VECTOR_TYPE
9925 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))))
9926 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == SSA_NAME
9927 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
9928 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
9930 gimple *def = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
9931 if (def)
9933 treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def);
9934 code = MINUS_EXPR;
9935 goto do_minus;
9939 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
9940 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
9941 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
9942 zero-extend. */
9943 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9944 && (modifier != EXPAND_SUM || mode != ptr_mode))
9946 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9947 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
9948 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
9949 return op1;
9950 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
9951 return op0;
9952 goto binop2;
9955 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9956 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
9957 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
9959 case MINUS_EXPR:
9960 case POINTER_DIFF_EXPR:
9961 do_minus:
9962 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
9963 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
9964 are constant. */
9965 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
9966 for the sake of an initializer. */
9967 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9968 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
9969 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
9971 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9972 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
9973 return simplify_gen_binary (MINUS, mode, op0, op1);
9976 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
9977 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
9978 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
9979 zero-extend. */
9980 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9981 && (modifier != EXPAND_SUM || mode != ptr_mode))
9982 goto binop;
9984 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
9985 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
9987 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
9988 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
9990 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
9991 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
9994 goto binop2;
9996 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
9997 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
9998 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9999 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
10000 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
10001 target, unsignedp);
10002 return target;
10004 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
10005 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
10006 Thus the following special case checks need only
10007 check the second operand. */
10008 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
10009 std::swap (treeop0, treeop1);
10011 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
10012 unsigned operand. */
10013 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
10014 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
10015 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
10017 machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
10018 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
10019 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode)
10020 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10022 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10023 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
10024 EXPAND_NORMAL);
10025 else
10026 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0,
10027 EXPAND_NORMAL);
10028 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
10029 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
10030 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
10032 op0 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op0, true);
10033 op1 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op1, false);
10034 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1,
10035 target, unsignedp));
10037 goto binop3;
10040 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
10041 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
10042 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10043 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
10044 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
10046 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10047 machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
10048 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
10049 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
10050 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
10052 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != INTEGER_CST)
10054 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode)
10055 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10057 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
10058 EXPAND_NORMAL);
10059 /* op0 and op1 might still be constant, despite the above
10060 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
10061 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
10063 widen_mult_const:
10064 op0 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op0, zextend_p);
10066 = convert_modes (mode, innermode, op1,
10067 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
10068 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1,
10069 target,
10070 unsignedp));
10072 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
10073 unsignedp, this_optab);
10074 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
10076 if (find_widening_optab_handler (other_optab, mode, innermode)
10077 != CODE_FOR_nothing
10078 && innermode == word_mode)
10080 rtx htem, hipart;
10081 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10082 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
10083 /* op0 and op1 might be constants, despite the above
10084 != INTEGER_CST check. Handle it. */
10085 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode && GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
10086 goto widen_mult_const;
10087 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
10088 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10089 hipart = gen_highpart (word_mode, temp);
10090 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (word_mode, hipart,
10091 op0, op1, hipart,
10092 zextend_p);
10093 if (htem != hipart)
10094 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
10095 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
10099 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
10100 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
10101 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10102 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
10104 case MULT_EXPR:
10105 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
10106 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
10107 multiplications. */
10108 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
10109 goto binop;
10111 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
10112 Thus the following special case checks need only
10113 check the second operand. */
10114 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
10115 std::swap (treeop0, treeop1);
10117 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
10118 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
10120 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
10121 && tree_fits_shwi_p (treeop1))
10123 tree exp1 = treeop1;
10125 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
10126 EXPAND_SUM);
10128 if (!REG_P (op0))
10129 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
10130 if (!REG_P (op0))
10131 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
10133 op1 = gen_int_mode (tree_to_shwi (exp1),
10134 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)));
10135 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0, op1));
10138 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10139 target = 0;
10141 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode) && optimize >= 2)
10143 gimple *def_stmt0 = get_def_for_expr (treeop0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
10144 gimple *def_stmt1 = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
10145 if (def_stmt0
10146 && !operand_equal_p (treeop1, gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt0), 0))
10147 def_stmt0 = NULL;
10148 if (def_stmt1
10149 && !operand_equal_p (treeop0, gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt1), 0))
10150 def_stmt1 = NULL;
10152 if (def_stmt0 || def_stmt1)
10154 /* X / Y * Y can be expanded as X - X % Y too.
10155 Choose the cheaper sequence of those two. */
10156 if (def_stmt0)
10157 treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt0);
10158 else
10160 treeop1 = treeop0;
10161 treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt1);
10163 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1,
10164 EXPAND_NORMAL);
10165 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
10166 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10167 start_sequence ();
10168 rtx divmul_ret
10169 = expand_expr_divmod (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, mode, treeop0, treeop1,
10170 op0, op1, NULL_RTX, unsignedp);
10171 divmul_ret = expand_mult (mode, divmul_ret, op1, target,
10172 unsignedp);
10173 rtx_insn *divmul_insns = get_insns ();
10174 end_sequence ();
10175 start_sequence ();
10176 rtx modsub_ret
10177 = expand_expr_divmod (TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, mode, treeop0, treeop1,
10178 op0, op1, NULL_RTX, unsignedp);
10179 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (MINUS_EXPR, type,
10180 optab_default);
10181 modsub_ret = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, modsub_ret,
10182 target, unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10183 rtx_insn *modsub_insns = get_insns ();
10184 end_sequence ();
10185 unsigned divmul_cost = seq_cost (divmul_insns, speed_p);
10186 unsigned modsub_cost = seq_cost (modsub_insns, speed_p);
10187 /* If costs are the same then use as tie breaker the other other
10188 factor. */
10189 if (divmul_cost == modsub_cost)
10191 divmul_cost = seq_cost (divmul_insns, !speed_p);
10192 modsub_cost = seq_cost (modsub_insns, !speed_p);
10195 if (divmul_cost <= modsub_cost)
10197 emit_insn (divmul_insns);
10198 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (divmul_ret);
10200 emit_insn (modsub_insns);
10201 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (modsub_ret);
10205 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10207 /* Expand X*Y as X&-Y when Y must be zero or one. */
10208 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
10210 bool gimple_zero_one_valued_p (tree, tree (*)(tree));
10211 bool bit0_p = gimple_zero_one_valued_p (treeop0, nullptr);
10212 bool bit1_p = gimple_zero_one_valued_p (treeop1, nullptr);
10214 /* Expand X*Y as X&Y when both X and Y must be zero or one. */
10215 if (bit0_p && bit1_p)
10216 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_and (mode, op0, op1, target));
10218 if (bit0_p || bit1_p)
10220 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
10221 int cost = add_cost (speed, mode) + neg_cost (speed, mode);
10222 struct algorithm algorithm;
10223 enum mult_variant variant;
10224 if (CONST_INT_P (op1)
10225 ? !choose_mult_variant (mode, INTVAL (op1),
10226 &algorithm, &variant, cost)
10227 : cost < mul_cost (speed, mode))
10229 target = bit0_p ? expand_and (mode, negate_rtx (mode, op0),
10230 op1, target)
10231 : expand_and (mode, op0,
10232 negate_rtx (mode, op1),
10233 target);
10234 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (target);
10239 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
10241 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
10242 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
10243 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
10244 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
10246 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
10247 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
10248 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
10249 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
10250 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
10251 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
10252 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
10253 divisions. */
10254 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
10255 goto binop;
10257 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10258 target = 0;
10259 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
10260 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
10261 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
10262 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10263 return expand_expr_divmod (code, mode, treeop0, treeop1, op0, op1,
10264 target, unsignedp);
10266 case RDIV_EXPR:
10267 goto binop;
10269 case MULT_HIGHPART_EXPR:
10270 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10271 temp = expand_mult_highpart (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
10272 gcc_assert (temp);
10273 return temp;
10275 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
10276 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10277 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10278 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10280 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10281 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10282 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
10283 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
10284 else
10285 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
10286 return target;
10288 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
10289 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10290 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10291 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10292 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
10293 return target;
10295 case FLOAT_EXPR:
10296 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10297 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10298 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10299 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
10300 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
10301 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
10302 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
10303 op0);
10304 expand_float (target, op0,
10305 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
10306 return target;
10308 case NEGATE_EXPR:
10309 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
10310 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10311 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10312 target = 0;
10313 temp = expand_unop (mode,
10314 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
10315 optab_default),
10316 op0, target, 0);
10317 gcc_assert (temp);
10318 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
10320 case ABS_EXPR:
10321 case ABSU_EXPR:
10322 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
10323 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10324 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10325 target = 0;
10327 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
10328 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
10329 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
10331 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
10332 risk generating incorrect code below. */
10333 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10334 return op0;
10336 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
10337 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
10339 case MAX_EXPR:
10340 case MIN_EXPR:
10341 target = original_target;
10342 if (target == 0
10343 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10344 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
10345 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
10346 || (REG_P (target)
10347 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
10348 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10349 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
10350 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10352 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
10353 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
10354 value. */
10355 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
10356 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
10357 OPTAB_WIDEN);
10358 if (temp != 0)
10359 return temp;
10361 if (VECTOR_TYPE_P (type))
10362 gcc_unreachable ();
10364 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
10365 code without it. */
10367 if (! REG_P (target))
10368 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10370 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
10371 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
10372 std::swap (op0, op1);
10374 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
10375 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
10376 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
10377 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
10380 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
10381 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
10383 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
10384 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
10385 else
10386 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10388 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
10389 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
10391 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
10392 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
10393 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
10394 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
10395 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
10396 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
10397 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
10399 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
10401 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
10402 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
10403 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
10404 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
10405 comparison_code = LT;
10408 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
10409 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
10411 rtx insn;
10413 start_sequence ();
10415 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
10416 insn = emit_conditional_move (target,
10417 { comparison_code,
10418 op0, cmpop1, mode },
10419 op0, op1, mode,
10420 unsignedp);
10422 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
10423 and return. */
10424 if (insn)
10426 rtx_insn *seq = get_insns ();
10427 end_sequence ();
10428 emit_insn (seq);
10429 return target;
10432 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
10433 branches. */
10434 end_sequence ();
10437 if (target != op0)
10438 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
10440 lab = gen_label_rtx ();
10441 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
10442 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL, lab,
10443 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
10445 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
10446 emit_label (lab);
10447 return target;
10449 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
10450 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
10451 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10452 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10453 target = 0;
10454 /* In case we have to reduce the result to bitfield precision
10455 for unsigned bitfield expand this as XOR with a proper constant
10456 instead. */
10457 if (reduce_bit_field && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10459 int_mode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (type);
10460 wide_int mask = wi::mask (TYPE_PRECISION (type),
10461 false, GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode));
10463 temp = expand_binop (int_mode, xor_optab, op0,
10464 immed_wide_int_const (mask, int_mode),
10465 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10467 else
10468 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
10469 gcc_assert (temp);
10470 return temp;
10472 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
10473 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
10474 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
10475 but that is probably not worth while. */
10477 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
10478 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
10479 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
10480 goto binop;
10482 case LROTATE_EXPR:
10483 case RROTATE_EXPR:
10484 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
10485 || type_has_mode_precision_p (type));
10486 /* fall through */
10488 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
10489 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
10491 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
10492 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
10493 shifts. */
10494 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
10495 goto binop;
10497 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
10498 subtarget = 0;
10499 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10500 target = 0;
10501 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
10502 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10504 /* Left shift optimization when shifting across word_size boundary.
10506 If mode == GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (word_mode), then normally
10507 there isn't native instruction to support this wide mode
10508 left shift. Given below scenario:
10510 Type A = (Type) B << C
10512 |< T >|
10513 | dest_high | dest_low |
10515 | word_size |
10517 If the shift amount C caused we shift B to across the word
10518 size boundary, i.e part of B shifted into high half of
10519 destination register, and part of B remains in the low
10520 half, then GCC will use the following left shift expand
10521 logic:
10523 1. Initialize dest_low to B.
10524 2. Initialize every bit of dest_high to the sign bit of B.
10525 3. Logic left shift dest_low by C bit to finalize dest_low.
10526 The value of dest_low before this shift is kept in a temp D.
10527 4. Logic left shift dest_high by C.
10528 5. Logic right shift D by (word_size - C).
10529 6. Or the result of 4 and 5 to finalize dest_high.
10531 While, by checking gimple statements, if operand B is
10532 coming from signed extension, then we can simplify above
10533 expand logic into:
10535 1. dest_high = src_low >> (word_size - C).
10536 2. dest_low = src_low << C.
10538 We can use one arithmetic right shift to finish all the
10539 purpose of steps 2, 4, 5, 6, thus we reduce the steps
10540 needed from 6 into 2.
10542 The case is similar for zero extension, except that we
10543 initialize dest_high to zero rather than copies of the sign
10544 bit from B. Furthermore, we need to use a logical right shift
10545 in this case.
10547 The choice of sign-extension versus zero-extension is
10548 determined entirely by whether or not B is signed and is
10549 independent of the current setting of unsignedp. */
10551 temp = NULL_RTX;
10552 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR
10553 && target
10554 && REG_P (target)
10555 && GET_MODE_2XWIDER_MODE (word_mode).exists (&int_mode)
10556 && mode == int_mode
10557 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1)
10558 && TREE_CODE (treeop0) == SSA_NAME)
10560 gimple *def = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (treeop0);
10561 if (is_gimple_assign (def)
10562 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (def) == NOP_EXPR)
10564 scalar_int_mode rmode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE
10565 (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def)));
10567 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (rmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (int_mode)
10568 && TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (word_mode)
10569 && ((TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1) + GET_MODE_BITSIZE (rmode))
10570 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (word_mode)))
10572 rtx_insn *seq, *seq_old;
10573 poly_uint64 high_off = subreg_highpart_offset (word_mode,
10574 int_mode);
10575 bool extend_unsigned
10576 = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def)));
10577 rtx low = lowpart_subreg (word_mode, op0, int_mode);
10578 rtx dest_low = lowpart_subreg (word_mode, target, int_mode);
10579 rtx dest_high = simplify_gen_subreg (word_mode, target,
10580 int_mode, high_off);
10581 HOST_WIDE_INT ramount = (BITS_PER_WORD
10582 - TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1));
10583 tree rshift = build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (treeop1), ramount);
10585 start_sequence ();
10586 /* dest_high = src_low >> (word_size - C). */
10587 temp = expand_variable_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode, low,
10588 rshift, dest_high,
10589 extend_unsigned);
10590 if (temp != dest_high)
10591 emit_move_insn (dest_high, temp);
10593 /* dest_low = src_low << C. */
10594 temp = expand_variable_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, word_mode, low,
10595 treeop1, dest_low, unsignedp);
10596 if (temp != dest_low)
10597 emit_move_insn (dest_low, temp);
10599 seq = get_insns ();
10600 end_sequence ();
10601 temp = target ;
10603 if (have_insn_for (ASHIFT, int_mode))
10605 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
10606 start_sequence ();
10607 rtx ret_old = expand_variable_shift (code, int_mode,
10608 op0, treeop1,
10609 target,
10610 unsignedp);
10612 seq_old = get_insns ();
10613 end_sequence ();
10614 if (seq_cost (seq, speed_p)
10615 >= seq_cost (seq_old, speed_p))
10617 seq = seq_old;
10618 temp = ret_old;
10621 emit_insn (seq);
10626 if (temp == NULL_RTX)
10627 temp = expand_variable_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
10628 unsignedp);
10629 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
10630 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
10631 return temp;
10634 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
10635 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
10636 case LT_EXPR:
10637 case LE_EXPR:
10638 case GT_EXPR:
10639 case GE_EXPR:
10640 case EQ_EXPR:
10641 case NE_EXPR:
10642 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
10643 case ORDERED_EXPR:
10644 case UNLT_EXPR:
10645 case UNLE_EXPR:
10646 case UNGT_EXPR:
10647 case UNGE_EXPR:
10648 case UNEQ_EXPR:
10649 case LTGT_EXPR:
10651 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
10652 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
10653 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
10654 if (temp)
10655 return temp;
10657 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
10658 type comparisons is have_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
10660 if ((target == 0
10661 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10662 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
10663 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
10664 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
10665 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
10666 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
10667 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
10668 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
10670 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
10672 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx ();
10673 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, lab1,
10674 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
10676 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10677 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
10678 else
10679 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
10681 emit_label (lab1);
10682 return target;
10684 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
10685 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
10686 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10687 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
10689 if (!target)
10690 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
10691 else
10692 /* If target overlaps with op1, then either we need to force
10693 op1 into a pseudo (if target also overlaps with op0),
10694 or write the complex parts in reverse order. */
10695 switch (GET_CODE (target))
10697 case CONCAT:
10698 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 0), op1))
10700 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (target, 1), op0))
10702 complex_expr_force_op1:
10703 temp = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)));
10704 emit_move_insn (temp, op1);
10705 op1 = temp;
10706 break;
10708 complex_expr_swap_order:
10709 /* Move the imaginary (op1) and real (op0) parts to their
10710 location. */
10711 write_complex_part (target, op1, true, true);
10712 write_complex_part (target, op0, false, false);
10714 return target;
10716 break;
10717 case MEM:
10718 temp = adjust_address_nv (target,
10719 GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target)), 0);
10720 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op1))
10722 scalar_mode imode = GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (target));
10723 temp = adjust_address_nv (target, imode,
10724 GET_MODE_SIZE (imode));
10725 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (temp, op0))
10726 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
10727 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
10729 break;
10730 default:
10731 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op1))
10733 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (target, op0))
10734 goto complex_expr_force_op1;
10735 goto complex_expr_swap_order;
10737 break;
10740 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
10741 write_complex_part (target, op0, false, true);
10742 write_complex_part (target, op1, true, false);
10744 return target;
10746 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
10748 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
10749 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
10751 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10752 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
10753 target, unsignedp);
10754 return target;
10757 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
10758 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
10759 case VEC_UNPACK_FIX_TRUNC_HI_EXPR:
10760 case VEC_UNPACK_FIX_TRUNC_LO_EXPR:
10762 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10763 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
10764 target, unsignedp);
10765 gcc_assert (temp);
10766 return temp;
10769 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
10770 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
10772 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10773 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
10774 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
10775 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
10776 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
10778 gcc_assert (temp);
10779 return temp;
10782 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
10783 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
10784 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_EVEN_EXPR:
10785 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_ODD_EXPR:
10786 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_HI_EXPR:
10787 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_LO_EXPR:
10788 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10789 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
10790 target, unsignedp);
10791 gcc_assert (target);
10792 return target;
10794 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
10795 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
10796 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
10797 subtarget = NULL_RTX;
10798 goto binop;
10800 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
10801 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (type)
10802 && VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
10803 && mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
10804 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
10806 class expand_operand eops[4];
10807 machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
10808 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
10809 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10810 this_optab = vec_pack_sbool_trunc_optab;
10811 enum insn_code icode = optab_handler (this_optab, imode);
10812 create_output_operand (&eops[0], target, mode);
10813 create_convert_operand_from (&eops[1], op0, imode, false);
10814 create_convert_operand_from (&eops[2], op1, imode, false);
10815 temp = GEN_INT (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type).to_constant ());
10816 create_input_operand (&eops[3], temp, imode);
10817 expand_insn (icode, 4, eops);
10818 return eops[0].value;
10820 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
10821 subtarget = NULL_RTX;
10822 goto binop;
10824 case VEC_PACK_FLOAT_EXPR:
10825 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
10826 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
10827 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10828 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, TREE_TYPE (treeop0),
10829 optab_default);
10830 target = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
10831 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
10832 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10833 gcc_assert (target);
10834 return target;
10836 case VEC_PERM_EXPR:
10838 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10839 vec_perm_builder sel;
10840 if (TREE_CODE (treeop2) == VECTOR_CST
10841 && tree_to_vec_perm_builder (&sel, treeop2))
10843 machine_mode sel_mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop2));
10844 temp = expand_vec_perm_const (mode, op0, op1, sel,
10845 sel_mode, target);
10847 else
10849 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
10850 temp = expand_vec_perm_var (mode, op0, op1, op2, target);
10852 gcc_assert (temp);
10853 return temp;
10856 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
10858 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
10859 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
10860 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
10862 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10863 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
10864 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
10865 target, unsignedp);
10866 return target;
10869 case SAD_EXPR:
10871 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
10872 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
10873 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
10875 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10876 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
10877 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
10878 target, unsignedp);
10879 return target;
10882 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
10884 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
10885 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
10886 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
10888 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
10889 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10890 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
10891 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
10892 target, unsignedp);
10893 gcc_assert (temp);
10894 return temp;
10897 case COND_EXPR:
10899 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
10900 conditional jump and is handled in
10901 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
10902 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
10904 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
10905 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
10906 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
10907 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
10909 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
10910 && !ignore
10911 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
10912 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
10914 temp = expand_cond_expr_using_cmove (treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
10915 if (temp)
10916 return temp;
10918 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
10919 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
10920 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
10921 temporary. */
10923 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10924 && original_target
10925 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
10926 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
10927 && !MEM_P (original_target))
10928 temp = original_target;
10929 else
10930 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1);
10932 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10933 NO_DEFER_POP;
10934 rtx_code_label *lab0 = gen_label_rtx ();
10935 rtx_code_label *lab1 = gen_label_rtx ();
10936 jumpifnot (treeop0, lab0,
10937 profile_probability::uninitialized ());
10938 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
10939 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
10940 false, false);
10942 emit_jump_insn (targetm.gen_jump (lab1));
10943 emit_barrier ();
10944 emit_label (lab0);
10945 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
10946 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
10947 false, false);
10949 emit_label (lab1);
10950 OK_DEFER_POP;
10951 return temp;
10954 case VEC_DUPLICATE_EXPR:
10955 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
10956 target = expand_vector_broadcast (mode, op0);
10957 gcc_assert (target);
10958 return target;
10960 case VEC_SERIES_EXPR:
10961 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
10962 return expand_vec_series_expr (mode, op0, op1, target);
10964 case BIT_INSERT_EXPR:
10966 unsigned bitpos = tree_to_uhwi (treeop2);
10967 unsigned bitsize;
10968 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
10969 bitsize = TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (treeop1));
10970 else
10971 bitsize = tree_to_uhwi (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
10972 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10973 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
10974 rtx dst = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10975 emit_move_insn (dst, op0);
10976 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos, 0, 0,
10977 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)), op1, false, false);
10978 return dst;
10981 default:
10982 gcc_unreachable ();
10985 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
10986 binop:
10987 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
10988 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10989 binop2:
10990 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
10991 binop3:
10992 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10993 target = 0;
10994 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
10995 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
10996 gcc_assert (temp);
10997 /* Bitwise operations do not need bitfield reduction as we expect their
10998 operands being properly truncated. */
10999 if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR
11000 || code == BIT_AND_EXPR
11001 || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
11002 return temp;
11003 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
11005 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
11008 /* Return TRUE if expression STMT is suitable for replacement.
11009 Never consider memory loads as replaceable, because those don't ever lead
11010 into constant expressions. */
11012 static bool
11013 stmt_is_replaceable_p (gimple *stmt)
11015 if (ssa_is_replaceable_p (stmt))
11017 /* Don't move around loads. */
11018 if (!gimple_assign_single_p (stmt)
11019 || is_gimple_val (gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt)))
11020 return true;
11022 return false;
11026 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, machine_mode tmode,
11027 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl,
11028 bool inner_reference_p)
11030 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
11031 tree type;
11032 int unsignedp;
11033 machine_mode mode, dmode;
11034 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
11035 rtx subtarget, original_target;
11036 int ignore;
11037 bool reduce_bit_field;
11038 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
11039 struct separate_ops ops;
11040 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
11041 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
11042 gimple *g;
11044 /* Some ABIs define padding bits in _BitInt uninitialized. Normally, RTL
11045 expansion sign/zero extends integral types with less than mode precision
11046 when reading from bit-fields and after arithmetic operations (see
11047 REDUCE_BIT_FIELD in expand_expr_real_2) and on subsequent loads relies
11048 on those extensions to have been already performed, but because of the
11049 above for _BitInt they need to be sign/zero extended when reading from
11050 locations that could be exposed to ABI boundaries (when loading from
11051 objects in memory, or function arguments, return value). Because we
11052 internally extend after arithmetic operations, we can avoid doing that
11053 when reading from SSA_NAMEs of vars. */
11054 #define EXTEND_BITINT(expr) \
11055 ((TREE_CODE (type) == BITINT_TYPE \
11056 && reduce_bit_field \
11057 && mode != BLKmode \
11058 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY \
11059 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE \
11060 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER \
11061 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS) \
11062 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), NULL_RTX, type) : (expr))
11064 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
11065 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
11066 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
11068 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
11069 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
11070 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
11072 default:
11073 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2); /* FALLTHRU */
11074 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1); /* FALLTHRU */
11075 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0); /* FALLTHRU */
11076 case 0: break;
11078 ops.code = code;
11079 ops.type = type;
11080 ops.op0 = treeop0;
11081 ops.op1 = treeop1;
11082 ops.op2 = treeop2;
11083 ops.location = loc;
11085 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
11086 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
11087 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
11088 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
11090 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
11091 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
11092 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
11093 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
11094 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
11095 && !type_has_mode_precision_p (type));
11097 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
11098 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
11099 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
11100 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
11101 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
11103 if (ignore)
11105 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
11106 return const0_rtx;
11108 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
11109 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
11110 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
11111 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
11112 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
11113 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
11115 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
11116 if (MEM_P (temp))
11117 copy_to_reg (temp);
11118 return const0_rtx;
11121 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
11122 || code == BIT_FIELD_REF
11123 || code == COMPONENT_REF
11124 || code == INDIRECT_REF)
11125 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
11126 modifier);
11128 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
11129 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
11130 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
11132 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
11133 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
11134 return const0_rtx;
11137 target = 0;
11140 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
11141 target = 0;
11143 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
11144 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
11145 original_target = target;
11147 switch (code)
11149 case LABEL_DECL:
11151 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
11153 temp = label_rtx (exp);
11154 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
11156 if (function != current_function_decl
11157 && function != 0)
11158 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
11160 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
11161 return temp;
11164 case SSA_NAME:
11165 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
11166 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
11167 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
11168 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
11169 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
11171 tree var = SSA_NAME_VAR (exp);
11172 if (var && DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
11173 return DECL_RTL (var);
11174 return gen_raw_REG (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
11175 LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER + 1);
11178 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
11179 /* For EXPAND_INITIALIZER try harder to get something simpler. */
11180 if (g == NULL
11181 && modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
11182 && !SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (exp)
11183 && (optimize || !SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)
11184 || DECL_IGNORED_P (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)))
11185 && stmt_is_replaceable_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp)))
11186 g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp);
11187 if (g)
11189 rtx r;
11190 location_t saved_loc = curr_insn_location ();
11191 loc = gimple_location (g);
11192 if (loc != UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
11193 set_curr_insn_location (loc);
11194 ops.code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (g);
11195 switch (get_gimple_rhs_class (ops.code))
11197 case GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS:
11198 ops.op2 = gimple_assign_rhs3 (g);
11199 /* Fallthru */
11200 case GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS:
11201 ops.op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (g);
11203 /* Try to expand conditonal compare. */
11204 if (targetm.gen_ccmp_first)
11206 gcc_checking_assert (targetm.gen_ccmp_next != NULL);
11207 r = expand_ccmp_expr (g, mode);
11208 if (r)
11209 break;
11211 /* Fallthru */
11212 case GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS:
11213 ops.op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (g);
11214 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (gimple_assign_lhs (g));
11215 ops.location = loc;
11216 r = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
11217 break;
11218 case GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS:
11220 r = expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs1 (g), target,
11221 tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
11222 inner_reference_p);
11223 break;
11225 default:
11226 gcc_unreachable ();
11228 set_curr_insn_location (saved_loc);
11229 if (REG_P (r) && !REG_EXPR (r))
11230 set_reg_attrs_for_decl_rtl (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), r);
11231 return r;
11234 ssa_name = exp;
11235 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
11236 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
11237 /* Optimize and avoid to EXTEND_BITINIT doing anything if it is an
11238 SSA_NAME computed within the current function. In such case the
11239 value have been already extended before. While if it is a function
11240 parameter, result or some memory location, we need to be prepared
11241 for some other compiler leaving the bits uninitialized. */
11242 if (!exp || VAR_P (exp))
11243 reduce_bit_field = false;
11244 goto expand_decl_rtl;
11246 case VAR_DECL:
11247 /* Allow accel compiler to handle variables that require special
11248 treatment, e.g. if they have been modified in some way earlier in
11249 compilation by the adjust_private_decl OpenACC hook. */
11250 if (flag_openacc && targetm.goacc.expand_var_decl)
11252 temp = targetm.goacc.expand_var_decl (exp);
11253 if (temp)
11254 return temp;
11256 /* Expand const VAR_DECLs with CONSTRUCTOR initializers that
11257 have scalar integer modes to a reg via store_constructor. */
11258 if (TREE_READONLY (exp)
11259 && !TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp)
11260 && (modifier == EXPAND_NORMAL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
11261 && immediate_const_ctor_p (DECL_INITIAL (exp))
11262 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
11263 && crtl->emit.regno_pointer_align_length
11264 && !target)
11266 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
11267 store_constructor (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, 0,
11268 int_expr_size (DECL_INITIAL (exp)), false);
11269 return target;
11271 /* ... fall through ... */
11273 case PARM_DECL:
11274 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
11275 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
11276 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
11277 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
11278 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
11279 layout_decl (exp, 0);
11281 /* fall through */
11283 case FUNCTION_DECL:
11284 case RESULT_DECL:
11285 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
11286 expand_decl_rtl:
11287 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
11289 /* DECL_MODE might change when TYPE_MODE depends on attribute target
11290 settings for VECTOR_TYPE_P that might switch for the function. */
11291 if (currently_expanding_to_rtl
11292 && code == VAR_DECL && MEM_P (decl_rtl)
11293 && VECTOR_TYPE_P (type) && exp && DECL_MODE (exp) != mode)
11294 decl_rtl = change_address (decl_rtl, TYPE_MODE (type), 0);
11295 else
11296 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
11298 /* Record writes to register variables. */
11299 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE
11300 && REG_P (decl_rtl)
11301 && HARD_REGISTER_P (decl_rtl))
11302 add_to_hard_reg_set (&crtl->asm_clobbers,
11303 GET_MODE (decl_rtl), REGNO (decl_rtl));
11305 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
11306 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
11307 definition. */
11308 if (exp)
11309 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
11311 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
11312 temp = 0;
11314 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
11315 been lowered by this point. */
11316 if (exp)
11318 tree context = decl_function_context (exp);
11319 gcc_assert (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (context)
11320 || context == current_function_decl
11321 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
11322 || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)
11323 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not
11324 TREE_STATIC. */
11325 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
11328 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
11329 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
11330 ??? We aren't parsing while expanding anymore. */
11332 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
11333 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
11335 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
11336 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
11338 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
11340 if (alt_rtl)
11341 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
11342 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
11343 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11344 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
11345 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (exp ? DECL_MODE (exp)
11346 : GET_MODE (decl_rtl),
11347 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
11348 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
11349 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
11350 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
11353 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
11354 if the address is a register. */
11355 if (temp != 0)
11357 if (exp && MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
11358 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
11360 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl))
11361 temp = decl_rtl;
11363 if (temp != 0)
11365 if (MEM_P (temp)
11366 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
11367 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
11368 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
11369 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11370 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
11371 && !inner_reference_p
11372 && mode != BLKmode
11373 && MEM_ALIGN (temp) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
11374 temp = expand_misaligned_mem_ref (temp, mode, unsignedp,
11375 MEM_ALIGN (temp), NULL_RTX, NULL);
11377 return EXTEND_BITINT (temp);
11380 if (exp)
11381 dmode = DECL_MODE (exp);
11382 else
11383 dmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (ssa_name));
11385 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl,
11386 there are two cases: we are dealing with a BLKmode value
11387 that is returned in a register, or we are dealing with
11388 a promoted value. In the latter case, return a SUBREG
11389 of the wanted mode, but mark it so that we know that it
11390 was already extended. */
11391 if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
11392 && dmode != BLKmode
11393 && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != dmode)
11395 machine_mode pmode;
11397 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
11398 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
11399 if (code != SSA_NAME)
11400 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
11401 else if ((g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
11402 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL
11403 && !gimple_call_internal_p (g))
11404 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
11405 gimple_call_fntype (g),
11407 else
11408 pmode = promote_ssa_mode (ssa_name, &unsignedp);
11409 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
11411 /* Some ABIs require scalar floating point modes to be passed
11412 in a wider scalar integer mode. We need to explicitly
11413 truncate to an integer mode of the correct precision before
11414 using a SUBREG to reinterpret as a floating point value. */
11415 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode)
11416 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (pmode)
11417 && known_lt (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)))
11418 return convert_wider_int_to_float (mode, pmode, decl_rtl);
11420 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
11421 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
11422 SUBREG_PROMOTED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
11423 return EXTEND_BITINT (temp);
11426 return EXTEND_BITINT (decl_rtl);
11428 case INTEGER_CST:
11430 if (TREE_CODE (type) == BITINT_TYPE)
11432 unsigned int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
11433 struct bitint_info info;
11434 bool ok = targetm.c.bitint_type_info (prec, &info);
11435 gcc_assert (ok);
11436 scalar_int_mode limb_mode
11437 = as_a <scalar_int_mode> (info.limb_mode);
11438 unsigned int limb_prec = GET_MODE_PRECISION (limb_mode);
11439 if (prec > limb_prec && prec > MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE)
11441 /* Emit large/huge _BitInt INTEGER_CSTs into memory. */
11442 exp = tree_output_constant_def (exp);
11443 return expand_expr (exp, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
11447 /* Given that TYPE_PRECISION (type) is not always equal to
11448 GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type)), we need to extend from
11449 the former to the latter according to the signedness of the
11450 type. */
11451 scalar_int_mode int_mode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (type);
11452 temp = immed_wide_int_const
11453 (wi::to_wide (exp, GET_MODE_PRECISION (int_mode)), int_mode);
11454 return temp;
11457 case VECTOR_CST:
11459 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
11460 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
11461 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
11462 scalar_int_mode int_mode;
11463 if (is_int_mode (mode, &int_mode))
11465 tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (int_mode, 1);
11466 if (type_for_mode)
11467 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR,
11468 type_for_mode, exp);
11470 if (!tmp)
11472 vec<constructor_elt, va_gc> *v;
11473 /* Constructors need to be fixed-length. FIXME. */
11474 unsigned int nunits = VECTOR_CST_NELTS (exp).to_constant ();
11475 vec_alloc (v, nunits);
11476 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < nunits; ++i)
11477 CONSTRUCTOR_APPEND_ELT (v, NULL_TREE, VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i));
11478 tmp = build_constructor (type, v);
11480 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
11481 tmode, modifier);
11484 case CONST_DECL:
11485 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE)
11487 /* Writing into CONST_DECL is always invalid, but handle it
11488 gracefully. */
11489 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
11490 scalar_int_mode address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
11491 op0 = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (exp, NULL_RTX, address_mode,
11492 EXPAND_NORMAL, as);
11493 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
11494 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
11495 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
11496 return temp;
11498 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
11500 case REAL_CST:
11501 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
11502 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
11504 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
11505 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
11506 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
11507 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
11508 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
11510 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
11511 return const_double_from_real_value (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
11512 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
11514 case FIXED_CST:
11515 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
11516 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
11518 case COMPLEX_CST:
11519 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
11520 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
11522 rtx rtarg, itarg;
11524 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
11525 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
11526 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
11528 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
11529 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
11530 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
11532 if (op0 != rtarg)
11533 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
11534 if (op1 != itarg)
11535 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
11537 return original_target;
11540 /* fall through */
11542 case STRING_CST:
11543 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
11545 /* temp contains a constant address.
11546 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
11547 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
11548 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11549 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
11550 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
11551 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
11552 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
11553 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
11554 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
11555 return temp;
11557 case POLY_INT_CST:
11558 return immed_wide_int_const (poly_int_cst_value (exp), mode);
11560 case SAVE_EXPR:
11562 tree val = treeop0;
11563 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl,
11564 inner_reference_p);
11566 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
11568 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
11569 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
11570 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
11571 with non-BLKmode values. */
11572 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
11574 val = build_decl (curr_insn_location (),
11575 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
11576 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
11577 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
11578 treeop0 = val;
11579 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
11580 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
11582 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
11583 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
11584 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
11587 return ret;
11591 case CONSTRUCTOR:
11592 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
11593 subexpressions. */
11594 if (ignore)
11596 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
11597 tree value;
11599 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
11600 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
11602 return const0_rtx;
11605 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
11607 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
11609 addr_space_t as
11610 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
11611 unsigned int align;
11613 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (exp, as, true);
11614 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
11615 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
11616 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
11617 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
11618 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
11619 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
11620 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
11621 && mode != BLKmode
11622 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
11623 temp = expand_misaligned_mem_ref (temp, mode, unsignedp,
11624 align, NULL_RTX, NULL);
11625 return EXTEND_BITINT (temp);
11628 case MEM_REF:
11630 const bool reverse = REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (exp);
11631 addr_space_t as
11632 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
11633 machine_mode address_mode;
11634 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
11635 gimple *def_stmt;
11636 unsigned align;
11637 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
11638 might end up in a register. */
11639 if (mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (exp))
11641 poly_int64 offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).force_shwi ();
11642 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
11643 poly_uint64 type_size;
11644 if (known_eq (offset, 0)
11645 && !reverse
11646 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (type), &type_size)
11647 && known_eq (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base)), type_size))
11648 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type, base),
11649 target, tmode, modifier);
11650 if (TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
11652 temp = assign_stack_temp (DECL_MODE (base),
11653 GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (base)));
11654 store_expr (base, temp, 0, false, false);
11655 temp = adjust_address (temp, BLKmode, offset);
11656 set_mem_size (temp, int_size_in_bytes (type));
11657 return temp;
11659 exp = build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, type, base, TYPE_SIZE (type),
11660 bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT));
11661 REF_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (exp) = reverse;
11662 return expand_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
11664 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
11665 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
11667 tree mask = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
11668 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
11669 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt), mask);
11670 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = base;
11672 align = get_object_alignment (exp);
11673 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
11674 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
11675 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
11677 rtx off = immed_wide_int_const (mem_ref_offset (exp), address_mode);
11678 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
11679 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
11681 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
11682 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
11683 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
11684 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
11685 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
11686 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE || modifier == EXPAND_MEMORY)
11687 return temp;
11688 if (!inner_reference_p
11689 && mode != BLKmode
11690 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
11691 temp = expand_misaligned_mem_ref (temp, mode, unsignedp, align,
11692 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
11693 ? NULL_RTX : target, alt_rtl);
11694 if (reverse)
11695 temp = flip_storage_order (mode, temp);
11696 return EXTEND_BITINT (temp);
11699 case ARRAY_REF:
11702 tree array = treeop0;
11703 tree index = treeop1;
11704 tree init;
11706 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
11707 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
11708 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
11709 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
11711 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11712 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
11713 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
11715 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
11717 if (t)
11718 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
11721 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
11722 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
11723 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
11724 that was declared const. */
11726 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11727 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
11728 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
11729 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
11730 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
11731 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
11733 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
11734 tree field, value;
11736 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
11737 field, value)
11738 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
11740 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
11741 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
11742 break;
11746 else if (optimize >= 1
11747 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
11748 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
11749 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
11750 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
11751 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST
11752 && (VAR_P (array) || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
11753 && (init = ctor_for_folding (array)) != error_mark_node)
11755 if (init == NULL_TREE)
11757 tree value = build_zero_cst (type);
11758 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
11760 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this optimization is only
11761 useful if this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR into
11762 memory. If it does, it is more efficient to just
11763 load the data from the array directly. */
11764 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
11765 modifier, true);
11766 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
11767 value = NULL_TREE;
11770 if (value)
11771 return expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
11773 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
11775 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
11776 tree field, value;
11778 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
11779 field, value)
11780 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
11782 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
11783 break;
11785 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
11787 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
11788 optimization is only useful if
11789 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
11790 into memory. If it does, it is more
11791 efficient to just load the data from
11792 the array directly. */
11793 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
11794 modifier, true);
11795 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
11796 break;
11799 return
11800 expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
11803 else if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
11805 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
11806 tree index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, treeop1);
11808 /* Optimize the special case of a zero lower bound.
11810 We convert the lower bound to sizetype to avoid problems
11811 with constant folding. E.g. suppose the lower bound is
11812 1 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion
11813 (ARRAY + (INDEX - (unsigned char)1))
11814 becomes
11815 (ARRAY + (-(unsigned char)1) + INDEX)
11816 which becomes
11817 (ARRAY + 255 + INDEX). Oops! */
11818 if (!integer_zerop (low_bound))
11819 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
11820 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
11821 low_bound));
11823 if (tree_fits_uhwi_p (index1)
11824 && compare_tree_int (index1, TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)) < 0)
11826 tree char_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
11827 scalar_int_mode char_mode;
11829 if (is_int_mode (TYPE_MODE (char_type), &char_mode)
11830 && GET_MODE_SIZE (char_mode) == 1)
11831 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
11832 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
11833 char_mode);
11838 goto normal_inner_ref;
11840 case COMPONENT_REF:
11841 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != CONSTRUCTOR);
11842 /* Fall through. */
11843 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
11844 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
11845 normal_inner_ref:
11847 machine_mode mode1, mode2;
11848 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
11849 tree offset;
11850 int reversep, volatilep = 0;
11851 tree tem
11852 = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
11853 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
11854 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
11855 bool clear_mem_expr = false;
11856 bool must_force_mem;
11858 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
11859 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
11860 infinitely recurse. */
11861 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
11863 /* Make sure bitpos is not negative, this can wreak havoc later. */
11864 if (maybe_lt (bitpos, 0))
11866 gcc_checking_assert (offset == NULL_TREE);
11867 offset = size_int (bits_to_bytes_round_down (bitpos));
11868 bitpos = num_trailing_bits (bitpos);
11871 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
11872 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
11873 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
11874 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
11875 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
11876 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
11877 to a larger size. */
11878 must_force_mem = offset != NULL_TREE
11879 || mode1 == BLKmode
11880 || (mode == BLKmode
11881 && !int_mode_for_size (bitsize, 1).exists ());
11883 const enum expand_modifier tem_modifier
11884 = must_force_mem
11885 ? EXPAND_MEMORY
11886 : modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier;
11888 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
11889 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
11890 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
11891 const rtx tem_target
11892 = TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
11893 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (tem))
11894 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem))) != INTEGER_CST
11895 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
11896 ? target
11897 : NULL_RTX;
11899 orig_op0 = op0
11900 = expand_expr_real (tem, tem_target, VOIDmode, tem_modifier, NULL,
11901 true);
11903 /* If the field has a mode, we want to access it in the
11904 field's mode, not the computed mode.
11905 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
11906 use BLKmode for it instead. */
11907 if (MEM_P (op0))
11909 if (mode1 != VOIDmode)
11910 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
11911 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
11912 op0 = adjust_address (op0, BLKmode, 0);
11915 mode2
11916 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
11918 /* See above for the rationale. */
11919 if (maybe_gt (bitpos + bitsize, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2)))
11920 must_force_mem = true;
11922 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
11923 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
11925 if (known_eq (bitpos, 0)
11926 && known_eq (bitsize, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
11927 && COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode1)
11928 && COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0))
11929 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE_INNER (mode1))
11930 == GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE_INNER (GET_MODE (op0)))))
11932 if (reversep)
11933 op0 = flip_storage_order (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
11934 if (mode1 != GET_MODE (op0))
11936 rtx parts[2];
11937 for (int i = 0; i < 2; i++)
11939 rtx op = read_complex_part (op0, i != 0);
11940 if (GET_CODE (op) == SUBREG)
11941 op = force_reg (GET_MODE (op), op);
11942 temp = gen_lowpart_common (GET_MODE_INNER (mode1), op);
11943 if (temp)
11944 op = temp;
11945 else
11947 if (!REG_P (op) && !MEM_P (op))
11948 op = force_reg (GET_MODE (op), op);
11949 op = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE_INNER (mode1), op);
11951 parts[i] = op;
11953 op0 = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode1, parts[0], parts[1]);
11955 return op0;
11957 if (known_eq (bitpos, 0)
11958 && known_eq (bitsize,
11959 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0))))
11960 && maybe_ne (bitsize, 0))
11962 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
11963 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
11965 else if (known_eq (bitpos,
11966 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0))))
11967 && known_eq (bitsize,
11968 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1))))
11969 && maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)
11970 && maybe_ne (bitsize, 0))
11972 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
11973 bitpos = 0;
11974 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
11976 else
11977 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
11978 must_force_mem = true;
11981 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
11982 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
11983 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
11984 && mode2 != BLKmode
11985 && targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode2, op0)
11986 && !must_force_mem)
11987 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
11989 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
11990 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
11991 is a legitimate constant. */
11992 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
11993 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
11995 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
11996 and need be, put it there. */
11997 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
11999 memloc = assign_temp (TREE_TYPE (tem), 1, 1);
12000 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
12001 op0 = memloc;
12002 clear_mem_expr = true;
12005 if (offset)
12007 machine_mode address_mode;
12008 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
12009 EXPAND_SUM);
12011 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
12013 address_mode = get_address_mode (op0);
12014 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
12016 /* We cannot be sure that the RTL in offset_rtx is valid outside
12017 of a memory address context, so force it into a register
12018 before attempting to convert it to the desired mode. */
12019 offset_rtx = force_operand (offset_rtx, NULL_RTX);
12020 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
12023 /* See the comment in expand_assignment for the rationale. */
12024 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
12025 && maybe_ne (bitpos, 0)
12026 && maybe_gt (bitsize, 0)
12027 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
12028 && multiple_p (bitpos, bitsize)
12029 && multiple_p (bitsize, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
12030 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
12032 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bytepos);
12033 bitpos = 0;
12036 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
12037 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
12040 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
12041 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
12042 if (MEM_P (op0)
12043 && known_eq (bitpos, 0)
12044 && offset != 0
12045 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
12046 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
12048 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
12049 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
12051 if (op0 == orig_op0)
12052 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
12054 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
12057 if (MEM_P (op0) && TREE_CODE (tem) == FUNCTION_DECL)
12059 if (op0 == orig_op0)
12060 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
12062 set_mem_align (op0, BITS_PER_UNIT);
12065 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
12066 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
12067 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
12068 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
12069 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
12070 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
12071 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
12072 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
12073 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
12074 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
12075 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
12076 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
12077 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
12078 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
12079 /* If the bitfield is volatile and the bitsize
12080 is narrower than the access size of the bitfield,
12081 we need to extract bitfields from the access. */
12082 || (volatilep && TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF
12083 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
12084 && mode1 != BLKmode
12085 && maybe_lt (bitsize, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode1) * BITS_PER_UNIT))
12086 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
12087 fetch it as a bit field. */
12088 || (mode1 != BLKmode
12089 && (((MEM_P (op0)
12090 ? MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
12091 || !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
12092 : TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
12093 || !multiple_p (bitpos, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
12094 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
12095 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
12096 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
12097 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
12098 : targetm.slow_unaligned_access (mode1,
12099 MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
12100 || !multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)))
12101 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
12102 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
12103 we must use bitfield operations. */
12104 || (known_size_p (bitsize)
12105 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
12106 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
12107 && maybe_ne (wi::to_poly_offset (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))),
12108 bitsize)))
12110 machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
12112 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
12113 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
12114 && MEM_P (target)
12115 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT)))
12116 ext_mode = int_mode_for_size (bitsize, 1).else_blk ();
12118 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
12120 if (target == 0)
12121 target = assign_temp (type, 1, 1);
12123 /* ??? Unlike the similar test a few lines below, this one is
12124 very likely obsolete. */
12125 if (known_eq (bitsize, 0))
12126 return target;
12128 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
12129 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
12130 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
12131 && (!target || MEM_P (target)));
12133 bytepos = exact_div (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT);
12134 poly_int64 bytesize = bits_to_bytes_round_up (bitsize);
12135 emit_block_move (target,
12136 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode, bytepos),
12137 gen_int_mode (bytesize, Pmode),
12138 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
12139 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
12141 return target;
12144 /* If we have nothing to extract, the result will be 0 for targets
12145 with SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED == 0 and garbage otherwise. Always
12146 return 0 for the sake of consistency, as reading a zero-sized
12147 bitfield is valid in Ada and the value is fully specified. */
12148 if (known_eq (bitsize, 0))
12149 return const0_rtx;
12151 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
12153 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
12154 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
12156 /* If the result has aggregate type and the extraction is done in
12157 an integral mode, then the field may be not aligned on a byte
12158 boundary; in this case, if it has reverse storage order, it
12159 needs to be extracted as a scalar field with reverse storage
12160 order and put back into memory order afterwards. */
12161 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
12162 && GET_MODE_CLASS (ext_mode) == MODE_INT)
12163 reversep = TYPE_REVERSE_STORAGE_ORDER (type);
12165 gcc_checking_assert (known_ge (bitpos, 0));
12166 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
12167 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
12168 ? NULL_RTX : target),
12169 ext_mode, ext_mode, reversep, alt_rtl);
12171 /* If the result has aggregate type and the mode of OP0 is an
12172 integral mode then, if BITSIZE is narrower than this mode
12173 and this is for big-endian data, we must put the field
12174 into the high-order bits. And we must also put it back
12175 into memory order if it has been previously reversed. */
12176 scalar_int_mode op0_mode;
12177 if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
12178 && is_int_mode (GET_MODE (op0), &op0_mode))
12180 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op0_mode);
12182 gcc_checking_assert (known_le (bitsize, size));
12183 if (maybe_lt (bitsize, size)
12184 && reversep ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
12185 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, op0_mode, op0,
12186 size - bitsize, op0, 1);
12188 if (reversep)
12189 op0 = flip_storage_order (op0_mode, op0);
12192 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
12193 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
12194 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). */
12195 if (mode == BLKmode)
12197 rtx new_rtx
12198 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode,
12199 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode),
12200 type);
12201 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
12202 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
12203 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
12206 return op0;
12209 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
12210 now as well. */
12211 if (mode == BLKmode)
12212 mode1 = BLKmode;
12214 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
12215 bytepos = bits_to_bytes_round_down (bitpos);
12216 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
12217 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
12218 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bytepos);
12219 else
12220 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bytepos);
12222 if (op0 == orig_op0)
12223 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
12225 /* Don't set memory attributes if the base expression is
12226 SSA_NAME that got expanded as a MEM or a CONSTANT. In that case,
12227 we should just honor its original memory attributes. */
12228 if (!(TREE_CODE (tem) == SSA_NAME
12229 && (MEM_P (orig_op0) || CONSTANT_P (orig_op0))))
12230 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
12232 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
12233 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
12235 /* If op0 is a temporary because the original expressions was forced
12236 to memory, clear MEM_EXPR so that the original expression cannot
12237 be marked as addressable through MEM_EXPR of the temporary. */
12238 if (clear_mem_expr)
12239 set_mem_expr (op0, NULL_TREE);
12241 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
12243 if (reversep
12244 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
12245 && modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
12246 op0 = flip_storage_order (mode1, op0);
12248 op0 = EXTEND_BITINT (op0);
12250 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
12251 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
12252 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
12253 return op0;
12255 if (target == 0)
12256 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
12258 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
12259 return target;
12262 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
12263 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
12265 case CALL_EXPR:
12266 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
12267 inlining. */
12268 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
12269 error ("invalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>");
12271 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
12273 if (fndecl
12274 /* Don't diagnose the error attribute in thunks, those are
12275 artificially created. */
12276 && !CALL_FROM_THUNK_P (exp)
12277 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
12278 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
12280 const char *ident = lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1);
12281 error ("call to %qs declared with attribute error: %s",
12282 identifier_to_locale (ident),
12283 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
12285 if (fndecl
12286 /* Don't diagnose the warning attribute in thunks, those are
12287 artificially created. */
12288 && !CALL_FROM_THUNK_P (exp)
12289 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
12290 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
12292 const char *ident = lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1);
12293 warning_at (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
12294 OPT_Wattribute_warning,
12295 "call to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
12296 identifier_to_locale (ident),
12297 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
12300 /* Check for a built-in function. */
12301 if (fndecl && fndecl_built_in_p (fndecl))
12303 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
12304 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
12307 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
12309 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
12310 op0 = NULL_RTX;
12312 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
12313 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
12314 if (mode == BLKmode
12315 && poly_int_tree_p (TYPE_SIZE (type))
12316 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
12317 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
12319 machine_mode mode1;
12320 poly_int64 bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
12321 tree offset;
12322 int reversep, volatilep = 0;
12323 tree tem
12324 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
12325 &unsignedp, &reversep, &volatilep);
12327 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
12328 if (!offset
12329 && multiple_p (bitpos, BITS_PER_UNIT, &bytepos)
12330 && !reversep
12331 && known_size_p (bitsize)
12332 && known_eq (wi::to_poly_offset (TYPE_SIZE (type)), bitsize))
12334 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
12335 rtx orig_op0
12336 = expand_expr_real (tem,
12337 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
12338 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
12339 != INTEGER_CST)
12340 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
12341 ? target : NULL_RTX),
12342 VOIDmode,
12343 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier,
12344 NULL, true);
12346 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
12348 op0 = orig_op0;
12350 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
12351 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
12352 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
12353 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
12354 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bytepos);
12355 else
12356 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bytepos);
12358 if (op0 == orig_op0)
12359 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
12361 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
12362 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
12363 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
12365 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
12370 if (!op0)
12371 op0 = expand_expr_real (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier,
12372 NULL, inner_reference_p);
12374 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
12375 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
12377 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
12378 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
12379 else if (mode != BLKmode
12380 && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
12381 && known_eq (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode),
12382 GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (op0)))
12383 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
12385 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
12386 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
12387 temp = gen_lowpart_common (mode, op0);
12388 if (temp)
12389 op0 = temp;
12390 else
12392 if (!REG_P (op0) && !MEM_P (op0))
12393 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
12394 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
12397 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
12398 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
12399 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
12400 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
12401 /* If the output type is a bit-field type, do an extraction. */
12402 else if (reduce_bit_field)
12403 return extract_bit_field (op0, TYPE_PRECISION (type), 0,
12404 TYPE_UNSIGNED (type), NULL_RTX,
12405 mode, mode, false, NULL);
12406 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
12407 different mode. */
12408 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
12410 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
12411 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
12412 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
12413 constants to change mode. */
12414 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
12416 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
12418 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
12419 target
12420 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
12421 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
12422 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), inner_type);
12424 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
12425 op0 = target;
12428 /* If OP0 is (now) a MEM, we need to deal with alignment issues. If the
12429 output type is such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate
12430 that it is. Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for
12431 non-BLKmode results. */
12432 if (MEM_P (op0))
12434 enum insn_code icode;
12436 if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE
12437 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
12438 && !inner_reference_p
12439 && mode != BLKmode
12440 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
12442 /* If the target does have special handling for unaligned
12443 loads of mode then use them. */
12444 if ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
12445 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
12447 rtx reg;
12449 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
12450 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
12451 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't
12452 fail. */
12453 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
12455 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
12456 rtx_insn *insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, op0);
12457 emit_insn (insn);
12458 return reg;
12460 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT)
12462 poly_uint64 mode_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
12463 poly_uint64 temp_size = mode_size;
12464 if (GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode)
12465 temp_size = upper_bound (temp_size,
12466 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0)));
12467 rtx new_rtx
12468 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, type);
12469 rtx new_with_op0_mode
12470 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
12472 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
12474 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
12476 rtx size_rtx = gen_int_mode (mode_size, Pmode);
12477 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0, size_rtx,
12478 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
12479 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM
12480 : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
12482 else
12483 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
12485 op0 = new_rtx;
12489 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
12492 return op0;
12494 case MODIFY_EXPR:
12496 tree lhs = treeop0;
12497 tree rhs = treeop1;
12498 gcc_assert (ignore);
12500 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
12501 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
12502 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
12503 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
12505 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
12506 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
12507 support it. */
12508 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
12509 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
12510 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
12511 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
12512 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
12513 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
12514 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
12516 rtx_code_label *label = gen_label_rtx ();
12517 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
12518 profile_probability prob = profile_probability::uninitialized ();
12519 if (value)
12520 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), label, prob);
12521 else
12522 jumpif (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), label, prob);
12523 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
12524 false);
12525 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
12526 emit_label (label);
12527 return const0_rtx;
12530 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, false);
12531 return const0_rtx;
12534 case ADDR_EXPR:
12535 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
12537 case REALPART_EXPR:
12538 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
12539 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
12541 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
12542 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
12543 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
12545 case RETURN_EXPR:
12546 case LABEL_EXPR:
12547 case GOTO_EXPR:
12548 case SWITCH_EXPR:
12549 case ASM_EXPR:
12550 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.cc. */
12551 gcc_unreachable ();
12553 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
12554 case CATCH_EXPR:
12555 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
12556 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
12557 case EH_ELSE_EXPR:
12558 /* Lowered by tree-eh.cc. */
12559 gcc_unreachable ();
12561 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
12562 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
12563 case TARGET_EXPR:
12564 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
12565 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
12566 case BIND_EXPR:
12567 case INIT_EXPR:
12568 case CONJ_EXPR:
12569 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
12570 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
12571 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
12572 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
12573 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
12574 case LOOP_EXPR:
12575 case EXIT_EXPR:
12576 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
12577 /* Lowered by gimplify.cc. */
12578 gcc_unreachable ();
12580 case FDESC_EXPR:
12581 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
12582 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
12583 gcc_unreachable ();
12585 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
12586 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
12587 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
12588 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
12589 modifier, alt_rtl, inner_reference_p);
12591 default:
12592 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
12595 #undef EXTEND_BITINT
12597 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
12598 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET.
12599 TYPE is known to be a partial integer type. */
12600 static rtx
12601 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
12603 scalar_int_mode mode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (type);
12604 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
12605 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE (exp) == VOIDmode || GET_MODE (exp) == mode)
12606 && (!target || GET_MODE (target) == mode));
12608 /* For constant values, reduce using wide_int_to_tree. */
12609 if (poly_int_rtx_p (exp))
12611 auto value = wi::to_poly_wide (exp, mode);
12612 tree t = wide_int_to_tree (type, value);
12613 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
12615 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12617 rtx mask = immed_wide_int_const
12618 (wi::mask (prec, false, GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)), mode);
12619 return expand_and (mode, exp, mask, target);
12621 else
12623 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) - prec;
12624 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, exp, count, target, 0);
12625 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, exp, count, target, 0);
12629 /* Subroutine of above: returns true if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
12630 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
12631 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
12633 static bool
12634 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
12636 /* Strip off any conversions. */
12637 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
12638 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
12640 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
12641 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
12642 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
12643 || !tree_fits_uhwi_p (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1))
12644 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
12645 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
12646 || !pow2p_hwi (tree_to_uhwi (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1)) + 1))
12647 return false;
12649 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
12650 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
12651 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
12652 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
12653 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
12655 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
12656 return false;
12658 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
12659 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
12660 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
12662 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
12663 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
12666 /* Return a STRING_CST corresponding to ARG's constant initializer either
12667 if it's a string constant, or, when VALREP is set, any other constant,
12668 or null otherwise.
12669 On success, set *PTR_OFFSET to the (possibly non-constant) byte offset
12670 within the byte string that ARG is references. If nonnull set *MEM_SIZE
12671 to the size of the byte string. If nonnull, set *DECL to the constant
12672 declaration ARG refers to. */
12674 static tree
12675 constant_byte_string (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset, tree *mem_size, tree *decl,
12676 bool valrep = false)
12678 tree dummy = NULL_TREE;
12679 if (!mem_size)
12680 mem_size = &dummy;
12682 /* Store the type of the original expression before conversions
12683 via NOP_EXPR or POINTER_PLUS_EXPR to other types have been
12684 removed. */
12685 tree argtype = TREE_TYPE (arg);
12687 tree array;
12688 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
12690 /* Non-constant index into the character array in an ARRAY_REF
12691 expression or null. */
12692 tree varidx = NULL_TREE;
12694 poly_int64 base_off = 0;
12696 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
12698 arg = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
12699 tree ref = arg;
12700 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ARRAY_REF)
12702 tree idx = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
12703 if (TREE_CODE (idx) != INTEGER_CST)
12705 /* From a pointer (but not array) argument extract the variable
12706 index to prevent get_addr_base_and_unit_offset() from failing
12707 due to it. Use it later to compute the non-constant offset
12708 into the string and return it to the caller. */
12709 varidx = idx;
12710 ref = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
12712 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
12713 return NULL_TREE;
12715 if (!integer_zerop (array_ref_low_bound (arg)))
12716 return NULL_TREE;
12718 if (!integer_onep (array_ref_element_size (arg)))
12719 return NULL_TREE;
12722 array = get_addr_base_and_unit_offset (ref, &base_off);
12723 if (!array
12724 || (TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL
12725 && TREE_CODE (array) != CONST_DECL
12726 && TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST))
12727 return NULL_TREE;
12729 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
12731 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
12732 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
12734 tree offset;
12735 tree str = string_constant (arg0, &offset, mem_size, decl);
12736 if (!str)
12738 str = string_constant (arg1, &offset, mem_size, decl);
12739 arg1 = arg0;
12742 if (str)
12744 /* Avoid pointers to arrays (see bug 86622). */
12745 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg))
12746 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg))) == ARRAY_TYPE
12747 && !(decl && !*decl)
12748 && !(decl && tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))
12749 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (*mem_size)
12750 && tree_int_cst_equal (*mem_size, DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))))
12751 return NULL_TREE;
12753 tree type = TREE_TYPE (offset);
12754 arg1 = fold_convert (type, arg1);
12755 *ptr_offset = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, type, offset, arg1);
12756 return str;
12758 return NULL_TREE;
12760 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == SSA_NAME)
12762 gimple *stmt = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (arg);
12763 if (!is_gimple_assign (stmt))
12764 return NULL_TREE;
12766 tree rhs1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
12767 tree_code code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (stmt);
12768 if (code == ADDR_EXPR)
12769 return string_constant (rhs1, ptr_offset, mem_size, decl);
12770 else if (code != POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
12771 return NULL_TREE;
12773 tree offset;
12774 if (tree str = string_constant (rhs1, &offset, mem_size, decl))
12776 /* Avoid pointers to arrays (see bug 86622). */
12777 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))
12778 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (rhs1))) == ARRAY_TYPE
12779 && !(decl && !*decl)
12780 && !(decl && tree_fits_uhwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))
12781 && tree_fits_uhwi_p (*mem_size)
12782 && tree_int_cst_equal (*mem_size, DECL_SIZE_UNIT (*decl))))
12783 return NULL_TREE;
12785 tree rhs2 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
12786 tree type = TREE_TYPE (offset);
12787 rhs2 = fold_convert (type, rhs2);
12788 *ptr_offset = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, type, offset, rhs2);
12789 return str;
12791 return NULL_TREE;
12793 else if (DECL_P (arg))
12794 array = arg;
12795 else
12796 return NULL_TREE;
12798 tree offset = wide_int_to_tree (sizetype, base_off);
12799 if (varidx)
12801 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (array)) != ARRAY_TYPE)
12802 return NULL_TREE;
12804 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (arg) == ARRAY_REF);
12805 tree chartype = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)));
12806 if (TREE_CODE (chartype) != INTEGER_TYPE)
12807 return NULL;
12809 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, varidx);
12812 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
12814 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
12815 *mem_size = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (array));
12816 if (decl)
12817 *decl = NULL_TREE;
12818 gcc_checking_assert (tree_to_shwi (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (array)))
12819 >= TREE_STRING_LENGTH (array));
12820 return array;
12823 tree init = ctor_for_folding (array);
12824 if (!init || init == error_mark_node)
12825 return NULL_TREE;
12827 if (valrep)
12829 HOST_WIDE_INT cstoff;
12830 if (!base_off.is_constant (&cstoff))
12831 return NULL_TREE;
12833 /* Check that the host and target are sane. */
12834 if (CHAR_BIT != 8 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8)
12835 return NULL_TREE;
12837 HOST_WIDE_INT typesz = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
12838 if (typesz <= 0 || (int) typesz != typesz)
12839 return NULL_TREE;
12841 HOST_WIDE_INT size = typesz;
12842 if (VAR_P (array)
12843 && DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)
12844 && tree_fits_shwi_p (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)))
12846 size = tree_to_shwi (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array));
12847 gcc_checking_assert (size >= typesz);
12850 /* If value representation was requested convert the initializer
12851 for the whole array or object into a string of bytes forming
12852 its value representation and return it. */
12853 unsigned char *bytes = XNEWVEC (unsigned char, size);
12854 int r = native_encode_initializer (init, bytes, size);
12855 if (r < typesz)
12857 XDELETEVEC (bytes);
12858 return NULL_TREE;
12861 if (r < size)
12862 memset (bytes + r, '\0', size - r);
12864 const char *p = reinterpret_cast<const char *>(bytes);
12865 init = build_string_literal (size, p, char_type_node);
12866 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
12867 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
12868 XDELETE (bytes);
12870 *mem_size = size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
12871 *ptr_offset = wide_int_to_tree (ssizetype, base_off);
12873 if (decl)
12874 *decl = array;
12876 return init;
12879 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
12881 /* Convert the 64-bit constant offset to a wider type to avoid
12882 overflow and use it to obtain the initializer for the subobject
12883 it points into. */
12884 offset_int wioff;
12885 if (!base_off.is_constant (&wioff))
12886 return NULL_TREE;
12888 wioff *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
12889 if (!wi::fits_uhwi_p (wioff))
12890 return NULL_TREE;
12892 base_off = wioff.to_uhwi ();
12893 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT fieldoff = 0;
12894 init = fold_ctor_reference (TREE_TYPE (arg), init, base_off, 0, array,
12895 &fieldoff);
12896 if (!init || init == error_mark_node)
12897 return NULL_TREE;
12899 HOST_WIDE_INT cstoff;
12900 if (!base_off.is_constant (&cstoff))
12901 return NULL_TREE;
12903 cstoff = (cstoff - fieldoff) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
12904 tree off = build_int_cst (sizetype, cstoff);
12905 if (varidx)
12906 offset = fold_build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (offset), offset, off);
12907 else
12908 offset = off;
12911 *ptr_offset = offset;
12913 tree inittype = TREE_TYPE (init);
12915 if (TREE_CODE (init) == INTEGER_CST
12916 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (array)) == INTEGER_TYPE
12917 || TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (inittype) == char_type_node))
12919 /* Check that the host and target are sane. */
12920 if (CHAR_BIT != 8 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8)
12921 return NULL_TREE;
12923 /* For a reference to (address of) a single constant character,
12924 store the native representation of the character in CHARBUF.
12925 If the reference is to an element of an array or a member
12926 of a struct, only consider narrow characters until ctors
12927 for wide character arrays are transformed to STRING_CSTs
12928 like those for narrow arrays. */
12929 unsigned char charbuf[MAX_BITSIZE_MODE_ANY_MODE / BITS_PER_UNIT];
12930 int len = native_encode_expr (init, charbuf, sizeof charbuf, 0);
12931 if (len > 0)
12933 /* Construct a string literal with elements of INITTYPE and
12934 the representation above. Then strip
12935 the ADDR_EXPR (ARRAY_REF (...)) around the STRING_CST. */
12936 init = build_string_literal (len, (char *)charbuf, inittype);
12937 init = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), 0);
12941 tree initsize = TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (inittype);
12943 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR && initializer_zerop (init))
12945 /* Fold an empty/zero constructor for an implicitly initialized
12946 object or subobject into the empty string. */
12948 /* Determine the character type from that of the original
12949 expression. */
12950 tree chartype = argtype;
12951 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (chartype))
12952 chartype = TREE_TYPE (chartype);
12953 while (TREE_CODE (chartype) == ARRAY_TYPE)
12954 chartype = TREE_TYPE (chartype);
12956 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (chartype)
12957 && TYPE_PRECISION (chartype) == TYPE_PRECISION (char_type_node))
12959 /* Convert a char array to an empty STRING_CST having an array
12960 of the expected type and size. */
12961 if (!initsize)
12962 initsize = integer_zero_node;
12964 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT size = tree_to_uhwi (initsize);
12965 if (size > (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INT_MAX)
12966 return NULL_TREE;
12968 init = build_string_literal (size, NULL, chartype, size);
12969 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
12970 init = TREE_OPERAND (init, 0);
12972 *ptr_offset = integer_zero_node;
12976 if (decl)
12977 *decl = array;
12979 if (TREE_CODE (init) != STRING_CST)
12980 return NULL_TREE;
12982 *mem_size = initsize;
12984 gcc_checking_assert (tree_to_shwi (initsize) >= TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
12986 return init;
12989 /* Return STRING_CST if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
12990 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the (possibly
12991 non-constant) offset in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing.
12992 If MEM_SIZE is non-zero the storage size of the memory is returned.
12993 If DECL is non-zero the constant declaration is returned if available. */
12995 tree
12996 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset, tree *mem_size, tree *decl)
12998 return constant_byte_string (arg, ptr_offset, mem_size, decl, false);
13001 /* Similar to string_constant, return a STRING_CST corresponding
13002 to the value representation of the first argument if it's
13003 a constant. */
13005 tree
13006 byte_representation (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset, tree *mem_size, tree *decl)
13008 return constant_byte_string (arg, ptr_offset, mem_size, decl, true);
13011 /* Optimize x % C1 == C2 for signed modulo if C1 is a power of two and C2
13012 is non-zero and C3 ((1<<(prec-1)) | (C1 - 1)):
13013 for C2 > 0 to x & C3 == C2
13014 for C2 < 0 to x & C3 == (C2 & C3). */
13015 enum tree_code
13016 maybe_optimize_pow2p_mod_cmp (enum tree_code code, tree *arg0, tree *arg1)
13018 gimple *stmt = get_def_for_expr (*arg0, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR);
13019 tree treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
13020 tree treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
13021 tree type = TREE_TYPE (*arg0);
13022 scalar_int_mode mode;
13023 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (TYPE_MODE (type), &mode))
13024 return code;
13025 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != TYPE_PRECISION (type)
13026 || TYPE_PRECISION (type) <= 1
13027 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)
13028 /* Signed x % c == 0 should have been optimized into unsigned modulo
13029 earlier. */
13030 || integer_zerop (*arg1)
13031 /* If c is known to be non-negative, modulo will be expanded as unsigned
13032 modulo. */
13033 || get_range_pos_neg (treeop0) == 1)
13034 return code;
13036 /* x % c == d where d < 0 && d <= -c should be always false. */
13037 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (*arg1) == -1
13038 && -wi::to_widest (treeop1) >= wi::to_widest (*arg1))
13039 return code;
13041 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
13042 wide_int w = wi::to_wide (treeop1) - 1;
13043 w |= wi::shifted_mask (0, prec - 1, true, prec);
13044 tree c3 = wide_int_to_tree (type, w);
13045 tree c4 = *arg1;
13046 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (*arg1) == -1)
13047 c4 = wide_int_to_tree (type, w & wi::to_wide (*arg1));
13049 rtx op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
13050 treeop0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), op0);
13052 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
13054 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
13056 location_t loc = gimple_location (stmt);
13057 struct separate_ops ops;
13058 ops.code = TRUNC_MOD_EXPR;
13059 ops.location = loc;
13060 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
13061 ops.op0 = treeop0;
13062 ops.op1 = treeop1;
13063 ops.op2 = NULL_TREE;
13064 start_sequence ();
13065 rtx mor = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (ops.type),
13066 EXPAND_NORMAL);
13067 rtx_insn *moinsns = get_insns ();
13068 end_sequence ();
13070 unsigned mocost = seq_cost (moinsns, speed_p);
13071 mocost += rtx_cost (mor, mode, EQ, 0, speed_p);
13072 mocost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (*arg1), mode, EQ, 1, speed_p);
13074 ops.code = BIT_AND_EXPR;
13075 ops.location = loc;
13076 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
13077 ops.op0 = treeop0;
13078 ops.op1 = c3;
13079 ops.op2 = NULL_TREE;
13080 start_sequence ();
13081 rtx mur = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (ops.type),
13082 EXPAND_NORMAL);
13083 rtx_insn *muinsns = get_insns ();
13084 end_sequence ();
13086 unsigned mucost = seq_cost (muinsns, speed_p);
13087 mucost += rtx_cost (mur, mode, EQ, 0, speed_p);
13088 mucost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (c4), mode, EQ, 1, speed_p);
13090 if (mocost <= mucost)
13092 emit_insn (moinsns);
13093 *arg0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (*arg0), mor);
13094 return code;
13097 emit_insn (muinsns);
13098 *arg0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (*arg0), mur);
13099 *arg1 = c4;
13100 return code;
13103 /* Attempt to optimize unsigned (X % C1) == C2 (or (X % C1) != C2).
13104 If C1 is odd to:
13105 (X - C2) * C3 <= C4 (or >), where
13106 C3 is modular multiplicative inverse of C1 and 1<<prec and
13107 C4 is ((1<<prec) - 1) / C1 or ((1<<prec) - 1) / C1 - 1 (the latter
13108 if C2 > ((1<<prec) - 1) % C1).
13109 If C1 is even, S = ctz (C1) and C2 is 0, use
13110 ((X * C3) r>> S) <= C4, where C3 is modular multiplicative
13111 inverse of C1>>S and 1<<prec and C4 is (((1<<prec) - 1) / (C1>>S)) >> S.
13113 For signed (X % C1) == 0 if C1 is odd to (all operations in it
13114 unsigned):
13115 (X * C3) + C4 <= 2 * C4, where
13116 C3 is modular multiplicative inverse of (unsigned) C1 and 1<<prec and
13117 C4 is ((1<<(prec - 1) - 1) / C1).
13118 If C1 is even, S = ctz(C1), use
13119 ((X * C3) + C4) r>> S <= (C4 >> (S - 1))
13120 where C3 is modular multiplicative inverse of (unsigned)(C1>>S) and 1<<prec
13121 and C4 is ((1<<(prec - 1) - 1) / (C1>>S)) & (-1<<S).
13123 See the Hacker's Delight book, section 10-17. */
13124 enum tree_code
13125 maybe_optimize_mod_cmp (enum tree_code code, tree *arg0, tree *arg1)
13127 gcc_checking_assert (code == EQ_EXPR || code == NE_EXPR);
13128 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (*arg1) == INTEGER_CST);
13130 if (optimize < 2)
13131 return code;
13133 gimple *stmt = get_def_for_expr (*arg0, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR);
13134 if (stmt == NULL)
13135 return code;
13137 tree treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
13138 tree treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
13139 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != SSA_NAME
13140 || TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
13141 /* Don't optimize the undefined behavior case x % 0;
13142 x % 1 should have been optimized into zero, punt if
13143 it makes it here for whatever reason;
13144 x % -c should have been optimized into x % c. */
13145 || compare_tree_int (treeop1, 2) <= 0
13146 /* Likewise x % c == d where d >= c should be always false. */
13147 || tree_int_cst_le (treeop1, *arg1))
13148 return code;
13150 /* Unsigned x % pow2 is handled right already, for signed
13151 modulo handle it in maybe_optimize_pow2p_mod_cmp. */
13152 if (integer_pow2p (treeop1))
13153 return maybe_optimize_pow2p_mod_cmp (code, arg0, arg1);
13155 tree type = TREE_TYPE (*arg0);
13156 scalar_int_mode mode;
13157 if (!is_a <scalar_int_mode> (TYPE_MODE (type), &mode))
13158 return code;
13159 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != TYPE_PRECISION (type)
13160 || TYPE_PRECISION (type) <= 1)
13161 return code;
13163 signop sgn = UNSIGNED;
13164 /* If both operands are known to have the sign bit clear, handle
13165 even the signed modulo case as unsigned. treeop1 is always
13166 positive >= 2, checked above. */
13167 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type) && get_range_pos_neg (treeop0) != 1)
13168 sgn = SIGNED;
13170 if (!TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
13172 if (tree_int_cst_sgn (*arg1) == -1)
13173 return code;
13174 type = unsigned_type_for (type);
13175 if (!type || TYPE_MODE (type) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (*arg0)))
13176 return code;
13179 int prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
13180 wide_int w = wi::to_wide (treeop1);
13181 int shift = wi::ctz (w);
13182 /* Unsigned (X % C1) == C2 is equivalent to (X - C2) % C1 == 0 if
13183 C2 <= -1U % C1, because for any Z >= 0U - C2 in that case (Z % C1) != 0.
13184 If C1 is odd, we can handle all cases by subtracting
13185 C4 below. We could handle even the even C1 and C2 > -1U % C1 cases
13186 e.g. by testing for overflow on the subtraction, punt on that for now
13187 though. */
13188 if ((sgn == SIGNED || shift) && !integer_zerop (*arg1))
13190 if (sgn == SIGNED)
13191 return code;
13192 wide_int x = wi::umod_trunc (wi::mask (prec, false, prec), w);
13193 if (wi::gtu_p (wi::to_wide (*arg1), x))
13194 return code;
13197 imm_use_iterator imm_iter;
13198 use_operand_p use_p;
13199 FOR_EACH_IMM_USE_FAST (use_p, imm_iter, treeop0)
13201 gimple *use_stmt = USE_STMT (use_p);
13202 /* Punt if treeop0 is used in the same bb in a division
13203 or another modulo with the same divisor. We should expect
13204 the division and modulo combined together. */
13205 if (use_stmt == stmt
13206 || gimple_bb (use_stmt) != gimple_bb (stmt))
13207 continue;
13208 if (!is_gimple_assign (use_stmt)
13209 || (gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt) != TRUNC_DIV_EXPR
13210 && gimple_assign_rhs_code (use_stmt) != TRUNC_MOD_EXPR))
13211 continue;
13212 if (gimple_assign_rhs1 (use_stmt) != treeop0
13213 || !operand_equal_p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (use_stmt), treeop1, 0))
13214 continue;
13215 return code;
13218 w = wi::lrshift (w, shift);
13219 wide_int a = wide_int::from (w, prec + 1, UNSIGNED);
13220 wide_int b = wi::shifted_mask (prec, 1, false, prec + 1);
13221 wide_int m = wide_int::from (wi::mod_inv (a, b), prec, UNSIGNED);
13222 tree c3 = wide_int_to_tree (type, m);
13223 tree c5 = NULL_TREE;
13224 wide_int d, e;
13225 if (sgn == UNSIGNED)
13227 d = wi::divmod_trunc (wi::mask (prec, false, prec), w, UNSIGNED, &e);
13228 /* Use <= floor ((1<<prec) - 1) / C1 only if C2 <= ((1<<prec) - 1) % C1,
13229 otherwise use < or subtract one from C4. E.g. for
13230 x % 3U == 0 we transform this into x * 0xaaaaaaab <= 0x55555555, but
13231 x % 3U == 1 already needs to be
13232 (x - 1) * 0xaaaaaaabU <= 0x55555554. */
13233 if (!shift && wi::gtu_p (wi::to_wide (*arg1), e))
13234 d -= 1;
13235 if (shift)
13236 d = wi::lrshift (d, shift);
13238 else
13240 e = wi::udiv_trunc (wi::mask (prec - 1, false, prec), w);
13241 if (!shift)
13242 d = wi::lshift (e, 1);
13243 else
13245 e = wi::bit_and (e, wi::mask (shift, true, prec));
13246 d = wi::lrshift (e, shift - 1);
13248 c5 = wide_int_to_tree (type, e);
13250 tree c4 = wide_int_to_tree (type, d);
13252 rtx op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
13253 treeop0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), op0);
13255 bool speed_p = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
13257 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
13259 location_t loc = gimple_location (stmt);
13260 struct separate_ops ops;
13261 ops.code = TRUNC_MOD_EXPR;
13262 ops.location = loc;
13263 ops.type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
13264 ops.op0 = treeop0;
13265 ops.op1 = treeop1;
13266 ops.op2 = NULL_TREE;
13267 start_sequence ();
13268 rtx mor = expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (ops.type),
13269 EXPAND_NORMAL);
13270 rtx_insn *moinsns = get_insns ();
13271 end_sequence ();
13273 unsigned mocost = seq_cost (moinsns, speed_p);
13274 mocost += rtx_cost (mor, mode, EQ, 0, speed_p);
13275 mocost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (*arg1), mode, EQ, 1, speed_p);
13277 tree t = fold_convert_loc (loc, type, treeop0);
13278 if (!integer_zerop (*arg1))
13279 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, MINUS_EXPR, type, t, fold_convert (type, *arg1));
13280 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, type, t, c3);
13281 if (sgn == SIGNED)
13282 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, PLUS_EXPR, type, t, c5);
13283 if (shift)
13285 tree s = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift);
13286 t = fold_build2_loc (loc, RROTATE_EXPR, type, t, s);
13289 start_sequence ();
13290 rtx mur = expand_normal (t);
13291 rtx_insn *muinsns = get_insns ();
13292 end_sequence ();
13294 unsigned mucost = seq_cost (muinsns, speed_p);
13295 mucost += rtx_cost (mur, mode, LE, 0, speed_p);
13296 mucost += rtx_cost (expand_normal (c4), mode, LE, 1, speed_p);
13298 if (mocost <= mucost)
13300 emit_insn (moinsns);
13301 *arg0 = make_tree (TREE_TYPE (*arg0), mor);
13302 return code;
13305 emit_insn (muinsns);
13306 *arg0 = make_tree (type, mur);
13307 *arg1 = c4;
13308 return code == EQ_EXPR ? LE_EXPR : GT_EXPR;
13311 /* Optimize x - y < 0 into x < 0 if x - y has undefined overflow. */
13313 void
13314 maybe_optimize_sub_cmp_0 (enum tree_code code, tree *arg0, tree *arg1)
13316 gcc_checking_assert (code == GT_EXPR || code == GE_EXPR
13317 || code == LT_EXPR || code == LE_EXPR);
13318 gcc_checking_assert (integer_zerop (*arg1));
13320 if (!optimize)
13321 return;
13323 gimple *stmt = get_def_for_expr (*arg0, MINUS_EXPR);
13324 if (stmt == NULL)
13325 return;
13327 tree treeop0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (stmt);
13328 tree treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (stmt);
13329 if (!TYPE_OVERFLOW_UNDEFINED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
13330 return;
13332 if (issue_strict_overflow_warning (WARN_STRICT_OVERFLOW_COMPARISON))
13333 warning_at (gimple_location (stmt), OPT_Wstrict_overflow,
13334 "assuming signed overflow does not occur when "
13335 "simplifying %<X - Y %s 0%> to %<X %s Y%>",
13336 op_symbol_code (code), op_symbol_code (code));
13338 *arg0 = treeop0;
13339 *arg1 = treeop1;
13343 /* Expand CODE with arguments INNER & (1<<BITNUM) and 0 that represents
13344 a single bit equality/inequality test, returns where the result is located. */
13346 static rtx
13347 expand_single_bit_test (location_t loc, enum tree_code code,
13348 tree inner, int bitnum,
13349 tree result_type, rtx target,
13350 machine_mode mode)
13352 gcc_assert (code == NE_EXPR || code == EQ_EXPR);
13354 tree type = TREE_TYPE (inner);
13355 scalar_int_mode operand_mode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (type);
13356 int ops_unsigned;
13357 tree signed_type, unsigned_type, intermediate_type;
13358 gimple *inner_def;
13360 /* First, see if we can fold the single bit test into a sign-bit
13361 test. */
13362 if (bitnum == TYPE_PRECISION (type) - 1
13363 && type_has_mode_precision_p (type))
13365 tree stype = signed_type_for (type);
13366 tree tmp = fold_build2_loc (loc, code == EQ_EXPR ? GE_EXPR : LT_EXPR,
13367 result_type,
13368 fold_convert_loc (loc, stype, inner),
13369 build_int_cst (stype, 0));
13370 return expand_expr (tmp, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
13373 /* Otherwise we have (A & C) != 0 where C is a single bit,
13374 convert that into ((A >> C2) & 1). Where C2 = log2(C).
13375 Similarly for (A & C) == 0. */
13377 /* If INNER is a right shift of a constant and it plus BITNUM does
13378 not overflow, adjust BITNUM and INNER. */
13379 if ((inner_def = get_def_for_expr (inner, RSHIFT_EXPR))
13380 && TREE_CODE (gimple_assign_rhs2 (inner_def)) == INTEGER_CST
13381 && bitnum < TYPE_PRECISION (type)
13382 && wi::ltu_p (wi::to_wide (gimple_assign_rhs2 (inner_def)),
13383 TYPE_PRECISION (type) - bitnum))
13385 bitnum += tree_to_uhwi (gimple_assign_rhs2 (inner_def));
13386 inner = gimple_assign_rhs1 (inner_def);
13389 /* If we are going to be able to omit the AND below, we must do our
13390 operations as unsigned. If we must use the AND, we have a choice.
13391 Normally unsigned is faster, but for some machines signed is. */
13392 ops_unsigned = (load_extend_op (operand_mode) == SIGN_EXTEND
13393 && !flag_syntax_only) ? 0 : 1;
13395 signed_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (operand_mode, 0);
13396 unsigned_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (operand_mode, 1);
13397 intermediate_type = ops_unsigned ? unsigned_type : signed_type;
13398 inner = fold_convert_loc (loc, intermediate_type, inner);
13400 rtx inner0 = expand_expr (inner, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
13402 if (CONST_SCALAR_INT_P (inner0))
13404 wide_int t = rtx_mode_t (inner0, operand_mode);
13405 bool setp = (wi::lrshift (t, bitnum) & 1) != 0;
13406 return (setp ^ (code == EQ_EXPR)) ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx;
13408 int bitpos = bitnum;
13410 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
13411 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (operand_mode) - 1 - bitpos;
13413 inner0 = extract_bit_field (inner0, 1, bitpos, 1, target,
13414 operand_mode, mode, 0, NULL);
13416 if (code == EQ_EXPR)
13417 inner0 = expand_binop (GET_MODE (inner0), xor_optab, inner0, const1_rtx,
13418 NULL_RTX, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
13419 if (GET_MODE (inner0) != mode)
13421 rtx t = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
13422 convert_move (t, inner0, 0);
13423 return t;
13425 return inner0;
13428 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
13429 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
13430 OPS reflects a comparison.
13432 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
13434 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
13435 available on this machine.
13437 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
13438 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
13439 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
13440 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
13441 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
13442 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
13443 set/jump/set sequence. */
13445 static rtx
13446 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, machine_mode mode)
13448 enum rtx_code code;
13449 tree arg0, arg1, type;
13450 machine_mode operand_mode;
13451 int unsignedp;
13452 rtx op0, op1;
13453 rtx subtarget = target;
13454 location_t loc = ops->location;
13456 arg0 = ops->op0;
13457 arg1 = ops->op1;
13459 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
13460 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
13461 return const0_rtx;
13463 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
13464 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
13465 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
13467 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
13468 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
13469 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
13470 return 0;
13472 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
13473 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
13474 if (targetm.have_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare ()
13475 && ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg0))
13476 && FUNC_OR_METHOD_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0))))
13477 || (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (arg1))
13478 && FUNC_OR_METHOD_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1))))))
13479 return 0;
13481 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
13482 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
13484 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
13485 all-ones or all-zeros mask. */
13486 if (VECTOR_TYPE_P (ops->type))
13488 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
13489 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (ops->type)
13490 && expand_vec_cmp_expr_p (TREE_TYPE (arg0), ops->type, ops->code))
13491 return expand_vec_cmp_expr (ops->type, ifexp, target);
13492 else
13493 gcc_unreachable ();
13496 /* Optimize (x % C1) == C2 or (x % C1) != C2 if it is beneficial
13497 into (x - C2) * C3 < C4. */
13498 if ((ops->code == EQ_EXPR || ops->code == NE_EXPR)
13499 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == SSA_NAME
13500 && TREE_CODE (arg1) == INTEGER_CST)
13502 enum tree_code new_code = maybe_optimize_mod_cmp (ops->code,
13503 &arg0, &arg1);
13504 if (new_code != ops->code)
13506 struct separate_ops nops = *ops;
13507 nops.code = ops->code = new_code;
13508 nops.op0 = arg0;
13509 nops.op1 = arg1;
13510 nops.type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
13511 return do_store_flag (&nops, target, mode);
13515 /* Optimize (x - y) < 0 into x < y if x - y has undefined overflow. */
13516 if (!unsignedp
13517 && (ops->code == LT_EXPR || ops->code == LE_EXPR
13518 || ops->code == GT_EXPR || ops->code == GE_EXPR)
13519 && integer_zerop (arg1)
13520 && TREE_CODE (arg0) == SSA_NAME)
13521 maybe_optimize_sub_cmp_0 (ops->code, &arg0, &arg1);
13523 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
13524 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
13525 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
13526 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
13527 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
13528 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
13530 switch (ops->code)
13532 case EQ_EXPR:
13533 code = EQ;
13534 break;
13535 case NE_EXPR:
13536 code = NE;
13537 break;
13538 case LT_EXPR:
13539 if (integer_onep (arg1))
13540 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
13541 else
13542 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
13543 break;
13544 case LE_EXPR:
13545 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
13546 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
13547 else
13548 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
13549 break;
13550 case GT_EXPR:
13551 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
13552 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
13553 else
13554 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
13555 break;
13556 case GE_EXPR:
13557 if (integer_onep (arg1))
13558 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
13559 else
13560 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
13561 break;
13563 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
13564 code = UNORDERED;
13565 break;
13566 case ORDERED_EXPR:
13567 code = ORDERED;
13568 break;
13569 case UNLT_EXPR:
13570 code = UNLT;
13571 break;
13572 case UNLE_EXPR:
13573 code = UNLE;
13574 break;
13575 case UNGT_EXPR:
13576 code = UNGT;
13577 break;
13578 case UNGE_EXPR:
13579 code = UNGE;
13580 break;
13581 case UNEQ_EXPR:
13582 code = UNEQ;
13583 break;
13584 case LTGT_EXPR:
13585 code = LTGT;
13586 break;
13588 default:
13589 gcc_unreachable ();
13592 /* Put a constant second. */
13593 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
13594 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
13596 std::swap (arg0, arg1);
13597 code = swap_condition (code);
13600 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
13601 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
13602 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
13603 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
13604 than an scc insn even if we have it. */
13606 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
13607 && (integer_zerop (arg1)
13608 || integer_pow2p (arg1))
13609 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) != 1 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)))
13611 tree narg0 = arg0;
13612 wide_int nz = tree_nonzero_bits (narg0);
13613 gimple *srcstmt = get_def_for_expr (narg0, BIT_AND_EXPR);
13614 /* If the defining statement was (x & POW2), then use that instead of
13615 the non-zero bits. */
13616 if (srcstmt && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt)))
13618 nz = wi::to_wide (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
13619 narg0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
13622 if (wi::popcount (nz) == 1
13623 && (integer_zerop (arg1)
13624 || wi::to_wide (arg1) == nz))
13626 int bitnum = wi::exact_log2 (nz);
13627 enum tree_code tcode = EQ_EXPR;
13628 if ((code == NE) ^ !integer_zerop (arg1))
13629 tcode = NE_EXPR;
13631 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
13632 return expand_single_bit_test (loc, tcode,
13633 narg0,
13634 bitnum, type, target, mode);
13639 if (! get_subtarget (target)
13640 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
13641 subtarget = 0;
13643 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
13645 if (target == 0)
13646 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
13648 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
13649 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
13650 operand_mode, unsignedp,
13651 (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) == 1
13652 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)) ? -1 : 1);
13655 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns true if successful,
13656 false otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction).
13658 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to the default
13659 label. */
13660 bool
13661 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
13662 rtx table_label, rtx default_label, rtx fallback_label,
13663 profile_probability default_probability)
13665 class expand_operand ops[5];
13666 scalar_int_mode index_mode = SImode;
13667 rtx op1, op2, index;
13669 if (! targetm.have_casesi ())
13670 return false;
13672 /* The index must be some form of integer. Convert it to SImode. */
13673 scalar_int_mode omode = SCALAR_INT_TYPE_MODE (index_type);
13674 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (omode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
13676 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
13678 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
13679 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
13680 index_expr, minval);
13681 minval = integer_zero_node;
13682 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
13683 if (default_label)
13684 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
13685 omode, 1, default_label,
13686 default_probability);
13687 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
13688 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
13690 else
13692 if (omode != index_mode)
13694 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (index_mode, 0);
13695 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
13698 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
13701 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
13703 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
13704 op2 = expand_normal (range);
13706 create_input_operand (&ops[0], index, index_mode);
13707 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[1], op1, TREE_TYPE (minval));
13708 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[2], op2, TREE_TYPE (range));
13709 create_fixed_operand (&ops[3], table_label);
13710 create_fixed_operand (&ops[4], (default_label
13711 ? default_label
13712 : fallback_label));
13713 expand_jump_insn (targetm.code_for_casesi, 5, ops);
13714 return true;
13717 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
13718 /* Subroutine of the next function.
13720 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
13721 in the table already subtracted.
13722 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
13723 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
13724 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
13726 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
13727 index value is out of range.
13728 DEFAULT_PROBABILITY is the probability of jumping to
13729 the default label. */
13731 static void
13732 do_tablejump (rtx index, machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
13733 rtx default_label, profile_probability default_probability)
13735 rtx temp, vector;
13737 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
13738 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
13740 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
13741 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
13742 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
13743 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
13744 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
13745 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
13746 the maximum value of the range. */
13748 if (default_label)
13749 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
13750 default_label, default_probability);
13752 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
13753 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
13754 if (mode != Pmode)
13756 unsigned int width;
13758 /* We know the value of INDEX is between 0 and RANGE. If we have a
13759 sign-extended subreg, and RANGE does not have the sign bit set, then
13760 we have a value that is valid for both sign and zero extension. In
13761 this case, we get better code if we sign extend. */
13762 if (GET_CODE (index) == SUBREG
13763 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (index)
13764 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_SIGNED_P (index)
13765 && ((width = GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode)))
13766 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
13767 && ! (UINTVAL (range) & (HOST_WIDE_INT_1U << (width - 1))))
13768 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 0);
13769 else
13770 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
13773 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
13774 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
13775 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
13776 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
13777 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
13778 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
13779 #endif
13781 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
13782 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
13783 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
13784 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
13785 index = simplify_gen_binary (MULT, Pmode, index,
13786 gen_int_mode (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE),
13787 Pmode));
13788 index = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, Pmode, index,
13789 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
13791 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
13792 if (flag_pic)
13793 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
13794 else
13795 #endif
13796 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
13797 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
13798 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
13799 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
13801 emit_jump_insn (targetm.gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
13803 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
13804 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
13805 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
13806 emit_barrier ();
13809 bool
13810 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
13811 rtx table_label, rtx default_label,
13812 profile_probability default_probability)
13814 rtx index;
13816 if (! targetm.have_tablejump ())
13817 return false;
13819 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
13820 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
13821 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
13822 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
13823 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
13825 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
13826 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
13827 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
13828 expand_normal (range),
13829 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
13830 table_label, default_label, default_probability);
13831 return true;
13834 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx representing vector mask for
13835 a VECTOR_CST of booleans. */
13836 static rtx
13837 const_vector_mask_from_tree (tree exp)
13839 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
13840 machine_mode inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
13842 rtx_vector_builder builder (mode, VECTOR_CST_NPATTERNS (exp),
13843 VECTOR_CST_NELTS_PER_PATTERN (exp));
13844 unsigned int count = builder.encoded_nelts ();
13845 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < count; ++i)
13847 tree elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
13848 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (elt) == INTEGER_CST);
13849 if (integer_zerop (elt))
13850 builder.quick_push (CONST0_RTX (inner));
13851 else if (integer_onep (elt)
13852 || integer_minus_onep (elt))
13853 builder.quick_push (CONSTM1_RTX (inner));
13854 else
13855 gcc_unreachable ();
13857 return builder.build ();
13860 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
13861 static rtx
13862 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
13864 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
13866 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
13867 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
13869 if (VECTOR_BOOLEAN_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
13870 return const_vector_mask_from_tree (exp);
13872 machine_mode inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
13874 rtx_vector_builder builder (mode, VECTOR_CST_NPATTERNS (exp),
13875 VECTOR_CST_NELTS_PER_PATTERN (exp));
13876 unsigned int count = builder.encoded_nelts ();
13877 for (unsigned int i = 0; i < count; ++i)
13879 tree elt = VECTOR_CST_ELT (exp, i);
13880 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
13881 builder.quick_push (const_double_from_real_value (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
13882 inner));
13883 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
13884 builder.quick_push (CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
13885 inner));
13886 else
13887 builder.quick_push (immed_wide_int_const (wi::to_poly_wide (elt),
13888 inner));
13890 return builder.build ();
13893 /* Build a decl for a personality function given a language prefix. */
13895 tree
13896 build_personality_function (const char *lang)
13898 const char *unwind_and_version;
13899 tree decl, type;
13900 char *name;
13902 switch (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options))
13904 case UI_NONE:
13905 return NULL;
13906 case UI_SJLJ:
13907 unwind_and_version = "_sj0";
13908 break;
13909 case UI_DWARF2:
13910 case UI_TARGET:
13911 unwind_and_version = "_v0";
13912 break;
13913 case UI_SEH:
13914 unwind_and_version = "_seh0";
13915 break;
13916 default:
13917 gcc_unreachable ();
13920 name = ACONCAT (("__", lang, "_personality", unwind_and_version, NULL));
13922 type = build_function_type_list (unsigned_type_node,
13923 integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
13924 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
13925 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
13926 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
13927 get_identifier (name), type);
13928 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
13929 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13930 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
13932 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
13933 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
13934 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
13936 return decl;
13939 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
13940 libfunc. */
13943 get_personality_function (tree decl)
13945 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
13946 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
13948 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
13949 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
13950 return NULL;
13952 if (!personality
13953 && pk == eh_personality_any)
13954 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
13956 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
13957 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
13959 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
13962 /* Returns a tree for the size of EXP in bytes. */
13964 static tree
13965 tree_expr_size (const_tree exp)
13967 if (DECL_P (exp)
13968 && DECL_SIZE_UNIT (exp) != 0)
13969 return DECL_SIZE_UNIT (exp);
13970 else
13971 return size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp));
13974 /* Return an rtx for the size in bytes of the value of EXP. */
13977 expr_size (tree exp)
13979 tree size;
13981 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == WITH_SIZE_EXPR)
13982 size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
13983 else
13985 size = tree_expr_size (exp);
13986 gcc_assert (size);
13987 gcc_assert (size == SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (size, exp));
13990 return expand_expr (size, NULL_RTX, TYPE_MODE (sizetype), EXPAND_NORMAL);
13993 /* Return a wide integer for the size in bytes of the value of EXP, or -1
13994 if the size can vary or is larger than an integer. */
13996 HOST_WIDE_INT
13997 int_expr_size (const_tree exp)
13999 tree size;
14001 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == WITH_SIZE_EXPR)
14002 size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
14003 else
14005 size = tree_expr_size (exp);
14006 gcc_assert (size);
14009 if (size == 0 || !tree_fits_shwi_p (size))
14010 return -1;
14012 return tree_to_shwi (size);